-. $Cambridge: exim/doc/doc-docbook/spec.xfpt,v 1.13 2006/12/19 12:28:35 ph10 Exp $
+. $Cambridge: exim/doc/doc-docbook/spec.xfpt,v 1.88 2010/06/14 18:51:09 pdp Exp $
.
. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
. This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
. converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printing and online
. formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
. The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
+.
+. WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
+. adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
+. unwanted vertical space.
. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
.include stdflags
.include stdmacs
-.docbook
-.book
. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
-. These definitions set some parameters and save some typing. Remember that
-. the <bookinfo> element must also be updated for each new edition.
+. This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
-.set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
-.set previousversion "4.63"
-.set version "4.64"
-
+.docbook
. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
-. Philip Hazel is developing in odd moments as a less cumbersome way of making
-. PostScript and PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all
-. other XML processors.
+. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
+. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
+. processors.
. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
.literal xml
<?sdop
+ foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
+ foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
- table_warn_soft_overflow="no"
+ table_warn_overflow="overprint"
?>
.literal off
+. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+. This generate the outermost <book> element that wraps then entire document.
+. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+
+.book
+
+. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+. These definitions set some parameters and save some typing. Remember that
+. the <bookinfo> element must also be updated for each new edition.
+. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+
+.set previousversion "4.72"
+.set version "4.73"
+
+.set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
+.set I " "
+
. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
. Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
.flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
. --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
-. --- table with four columns.
+. --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
+. --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
+. --- index entry.
.macro option
+.arg 5
+.oindex "&%$5%&"
+.endarg
+.arg -5
.oindex "&%$1%&"
-.itable all 0 0 4 8* left 5* center 5* center 6* right
+.endarg
+.itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
.row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
.endtable
.endmacro
.itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
.endmacro
-. --- Macros for the concept and option index entries. For a "range" style of
-. --- entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The first
-. --- argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the ID
-. --- that ties them together.
+. --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
+. --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
+. --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
+
+.macro irow
+.arg 4
+.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
+.endarg
+.arg -4
+.arg 3
+.row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
+.endarg
+.arg -3
+.row "&I;$1" "$2"
+.endarg
+.endarg
+.endmacro
+
+. --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
+. --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
+. --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
+. --- ID that ties them together.
.macro cindex
&<indexterm role="concept">&
&</indexterm>&
.endmacro
+.macro vindex
+&<indexterm role="variable">&
+&<primary>&$1&</primary>&
+.arg 2
+&<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
+.endarg
+&</indexterm>&
+.endmacro
+
.macro index
-.echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex"
+.echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
.endmacro
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
<bookinfo>
<title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
<titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
-<date>11 December 2006</date>
-<author><firstname>Philip</firstname><surname>Hazel</surname></author>
-<authorinitials>PH</authorinitials>
-<affiliation><orgname>University of Cambridge Computing Service</orgname></affiliation>
-<address>New Museums Site, Pembroke Street, Cambridge CB2 3QH, England</address>
+<date>29 May 2010</date>
+<author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
+<authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
<revhistory><revision>
- <revnumber>4.64</revnumber>
- <date>11 December 2006</date>
- <authorinitials>PH</authorinitials>
+ <revnumber>4.73</revnumber>
+ <date>19 Nov 2010</date>
+ <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
</revision></revhistory>
-<copyright><year>2006</year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
+<copyright><year>2009</year><holder>University of Cambridge</holder></copyright>
</bookinfo>
.literal off
. at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
-.chapter "Introduction"
+.chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
.literal xml
-<indexterm role="concept">
+<indexterm role="variable">
<primary>$1, $2, etc.</primary>
<see><emphasis>numerical variables</emphasis></see>
</indexterm>
</indexterm>
<indexterm role="concept">
<primary>maximum</primary>
- <see><emphasis>limit</emphasis></see>
+ <seealso><emphasis>limit</emphasis></seealso>
</indexterm>
<indexterm role="concept">
<primary>monitor</primary>
contributors.
-.section "Exim documentation"
+.section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
+. Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
.new
.cindex "documentation"
This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version; of Exim.
.cindex "books about Exim"
An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
-SMTP Mail Server'&, published by UIT Cambridge
+SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
(&url(http://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
This book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
.cindex "Debian" "information sources"
If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
Debian-specific features in the file
-.display
-&_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&
-.endd
+&_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
information.
.row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
.row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
.row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
-.row &_pcrepattern.txt_& "specification of PCRE regular expressions"
-.row &_pcretest.txt_& "specification of the PCRE testing program"
.row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
.row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
.endtable
-.section "FTP and web sites"
+.section "FTP and web sites" "SECID2"
.cindex "web site"
.cindex "FTP site"
The primary site for Exim source distributions is currently the University of
.cindex "wiki"
.cindex "FAQ"
As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim web site contains a number of
-differently formatted versions of the documentation, including the FAQ in both
-text and HTML formats. The HTML version comes with a keyword-in-context index.
-A recent addition to the online information is the Exim wiki
-(&url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/)). We hope that this will make it easier
-for Exim users to contribute examples, tips, and know-how for the benefit of
-others.
+differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
+online information is the Exim wiki (&url(http://wiki.exim.org)),
+which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
+examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
+
+.cindex Bugzilla
+An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(http://bugs.exim.org). You can use
+this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
+first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
-.section "Mailing lists"
+.section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
.cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
-The following are the three main Exim mailing lists:
+The following Exim mailing lists exist:
.table2 140pt
-.row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "general discussion list"
-.row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
-.row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "moderated, low volume announcements list"
+.row &'exim-users@exim.org'& "General discussion list"
+.row &'exim-dev@exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
+.row &'exim-announce@exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
+.row &'exim-future@exim.org'& "Discussion of long-term development"
.endtable
You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
Please ask Debian-specific questions on this list and not on the general Exim
lists.
-.section "Exim training"
+.section "Exim training" "SECID4"
.cindex "training courses"
-From time to time (approximately annually at the time of writing), training
-courses are run by the author of Exim in Cambridge, UK. Details of any
-forthcoming courses can be found on the web site
-&url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
+Training courses in Cambridge (UK) used to be run annually by the author of
+Exim, before he retired. At the time of writing, there are no plans to run
+further Exim courses in Cambridge. However, if that changes, relevant
+information will be posted at &url(http://www-tus.csx.cam.ac.uk/courses/exim/).
-
-.section "Bug reports"
+.section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
.cindex "bug reports"
.cindex "reporting bugs"
-Reports of obvious bugs should be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'&. However, if you
-are unsure whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to
-post a message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
+Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
+via the Bugzilla (&url(http://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
+whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
+message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
.cindex "distribution" "signing details"
.cindex "distribution" "public key"
.cindex "public key for signed distribution"
-The distributions are currently signed with Philip Hazel's GPG key. The
+The distributions are currently signed with Nigel Metheringham's GPG key. The
corresponding public key is available from a number of keyservers, and there is
-also a copy in the file &_Public-Key_&. The signatures for the tar bundles are
+also a copy in the file &_nigel-pubkey.asc_&. The signatures for the tar bundles are
in:
.display
-&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.sig_&
-&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.sig_&
+&_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
+&_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
.endd
For each released version, the log of changes is made separately available in a
separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
.endd
These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& as well as &_.gz_& forms.
-.cindex "FAQ"
-The FAQ is available for downloading in two different formats in these files:
-.display
-&_exim4/FAQ.txt.gz_&
-&_exim4/FAQ.html.tar.gz_&
-.endd
-The first of these is a single ASCII file that can be searched with a text
-editor. The second is a directory of HTML files, normally accessed by starting
-at &_index.html_&. The HTML version of the FAQ (which is also included in the
-HTML documentation tarbundle) includes a keyword-in-context index, which is
-often the most convenient way of finding your way around.
-
-
-.section "Wish list"
-.cindex "wish list"
-A wish list is maintained, containing ideas for new features that have been
-submitted. This used to be a single file that from time to time was exported to
-the ftp site into the file &_exim4/WishList_&. However, it has now been
-imported into Exim's Bugzilla data.
-.section "Contributed material"
-.cindex "contributed material"
-At the ftp site, there is a directory called &_Contrib_& that contains
-miscellaneous files contributed to the Exim community by Exim users. There is
-also a collection of contributed configuration examples in
-&_exim4/config.samples.tar.gz_&. These samples are referenced from the FAQ.
-
-
-
-.section "Limitations"
+.section "Limitations" "SECID6"
.ilist
.cindex "limitations of Exim"
.cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
.endlist
-.section "Run time configuration"
+.section "Run time configuration" "SECID7"
Exim's run time configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
-.section "Calling interface"
+.section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
-.section "Terminology"
+.section "Terminology" "SECID9"
.cindex "terminology definitions"
.cindex "body of message" "definition of"
The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
the part of an email address following the @ sign.
-.cindex "envelope" "definition of"
+.cindex "envelope, definition of"
.cindex "sender" "definition of"
A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
-.cindex "message header" "definition of"
+.cindex "message" "header, definition of"
.cindex "header section" "definition of"
The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
@ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
.cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
-.cindex "remote delivery" "definition of"
+.cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
-.chapter "Incorporated code"
+.chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
.cindex "incorporated code"
.cindex "regular expressions" "library"
.cindex "PCRE"
A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
.ilist
-Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the Exim
-monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright ©
-University of Cambridge. The source is distributed in the directory
-&_src/pcre_&. However, this is a cut-down version of PCRE. If you want to use
-the PCRE library in other programs, you should obtain and install the full
-version from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
-.next
-.cindex "cdb" "acknowledgement"
+Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
+Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE library, copyright
+© University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE is no longer shipped with
+Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE shipped with your system,
+or obtain and install the full version of the library from
+&url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre).
+.next
+.cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
version.
-
This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
-&url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows some
-code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license restrictions
-applied to it).
+&url(http://www.pobox.com/~djb/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
+some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
+restrictions applied to it).
.endblockquote
.next
.cindex "SPA authentication"
.endblockquote
.next
-.cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgement"
+.cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
.cindex "X-windows"
.cindex "Athena"
The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
.next
Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
not covered by any specific licence requirements. It is assumed that the
-contributors are happy to see their code incoporated into Exim under the GPL.
+contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
.endlist
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
-.chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "" &&&
+.chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
"Receiving and delivering mail"
-.section "Overall philosophy"
+.section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
.cindex "design philosophy"
Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
-.section "Policy control"
+.section "Policy control" "SECID11"
.cindex "policy control" "overview"
Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs being abused as
which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
.next
When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
-host, but before the final acknowledgement has been sent, a locally supplied C
+host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
-.section "User filters"
+.section "User filters" "SECID12"
.cindex "filter" "introduction"
.cindex "Sieve filter"
In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
.next
There are two different possibilities for the final two characters:
.olist
-.cindex "&%localhost_number%&"
+.oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
time of reception, normally in units of 1/2000 of a second, but for systems
that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
will already have ticked while the message was being received.
-.section "Receiving mail"
+.section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
.cindex "receiving mail"
.cindex "message" "reception"
The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
.endlist
-.cindex "message sender" "constructed by Exim"
+.cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
.cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
-.section "Handling an incoming message"
+.section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
.cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
.cindex "file" "how a message is held"
When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
-.section "Life of a message"
+.section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
.cindex "message" "life of"
.cindex "message" "frozen"
A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
to be sent.
-.cindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
-.cindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
+.oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
+.oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
&%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to any frozen messages.
-.section "Processing an address for verification"
+.section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
.cindex "router" "for verification"
.cindex "verifying address" "overview"
As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
&'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
transport, or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
original address ceases,
-.cindex "&%unseen%& option"
+.oindex "&%unseen%&"
unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
facility for this purpose.
-.section "Duplicate addresses"
+.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
.cindex "case of local parts"
-.cindex "address duplicate" "discarding"
+.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
.cindex "duplicate addresses"
Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
and remote transports, and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
.section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
-.cindex "router preconditions" "order of processing"
+.cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
.cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
of domains that it defines.
.next
-.cindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
-.cindex "&$local_part$&"
-.cindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
+.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
+.vindex "&$local_part$&"
+.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
the set of local parts that it defines. If &%local_part_prefix%& or
&%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&, and
&$local_part_suffix$& as necessary.
.next
-.cindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
-.cindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
-.cindex "&$home$&"
+.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
+.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
+.vindex "&$home$&"
If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
-.section "Delivery in detail"
+.section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
.cindex "delivery" "in detail"
When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
-.section "Retry mechanism"
+.section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
.cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
.cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
.cindex "queue runner"
-.section "Temporary delivery failure"
+.section "Temporary delivery failure" "SECID20"
.cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
-.section "Permanent delivery failure"
+.section "Permanent delivery failure" "SECID21"
.cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
.cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
-.section "Failures to deliver bounce messages"
+.section "Failures to deliver bounce messages" "SECID22"
.cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left on the queue,
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
-.chapter "Building and installing Exim"
+.chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
.scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
-.section "Unpacking"
-Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when upacked,
+.section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
+Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
&_exim-&version;_&) into which the following files are placed:
.table2 140pt
-.row &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
-.row &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are documented"
-.row &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
-.row &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
-.row &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
-.row &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
- instructions"
+.irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
+.irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
+ documented"
+.irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
+.irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
+.irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
+.irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
+ instructions"
.endtable
Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
following subdirectories are created:
.table2 140pt
-.row &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
-.row &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
-.row &_doc_& "documentation files"
-.row &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
-.row &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
-.row &_src_& "remaining source files"
-.row &_util_& "independent utilities"
+.irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
+.irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
+.irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
+.irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
+.irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
+.irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
+.irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
.endtable
The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory, and are built
that may be useful to some sites.
-.section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems"
+.section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
.cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
overridden if necessary.
+.section "PCRE library" "SECTpcre"
+.cindex "PCRE library"
+Exim no longer has an embedded PCRE library as the vast majority of
+modern systems include PCRE as a system library, although you may need
+to install the PCRE or PCRE development package for your operating
+system. If your system has a normal PCRE installation the Exim build
+process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
+headers are in an unusual location you will need to set the PCRE_LIBS
+and INCLUDE directives appropriately. If your operating system has no
+PCRE support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE
+from &url(ftp://ftp.csx.cam.ac.uk/pub/software/programming/pcre/).
+
.section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
.cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
.cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
different operating systems often have different ones installed.
.cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
-.cindex "IRIX" "DBM library for"
-.cindex "BSD" "DBM library for"
-.cindex "Linux" "DBM library for"
+.cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
+.cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
+.cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
-versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardised on the
+versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
Berkeley DB library.
Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
-.section "Pre-building configuration"
+.section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
.cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
.cindex "configuration for building Exim"
.cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
-.section "Support for iconv()"
+.section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
.cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
.cindex "RFC 2047"
The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
-.section "Use of tcpwrappers"
-.cindex "tcpwrappers" "building Exim to support"
+.section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
+.cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
.cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
+.cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
+.cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
.endd
-in &_Local/Makefile_&. The name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control files is
-&"exim"&. For example, the line
+in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
+files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
.code
exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
.endd
in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
-All other connections are denied. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
+All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
+can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
+in &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
+configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
further details.
-.section "Including support for IPv6"
+.section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
.cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
&`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
library files.
Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
-defined. AAAA records (analagous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
+defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&. It is not known
-.section "The building process"
+.section "The building process" "SECID29"
.cindex "build directory"
Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
-.section 'Output from &"make"&'
+.section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
.section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
-.cindex "build-time options" "overriding"
+.cindex "build-time options, overriding"
The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
-.cindex "X11 libraries" "location of"
+.cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
&_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
-.section "OS-specific header files"
+.section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
.cindex "&_os.h_&"
.cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
-.section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor"
-.cindex "building Eximon" "overriding default options"
+.section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
+.cindex "building Eximon"
A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
where the files that are involved are
.display
.ecindex IIDbuex
-.section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts"
+.section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
.cindex "installing Exim"
.cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
.cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
-&'convert4r4'&, or the &'pcretest'& test program. You will probably run the
-first of these only once (if you are upgrading from Exim 3), and the second
-isn't really part of Exim. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
+&'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
+upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
-.section "Setting up the spool directory"
+.section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
.cindex "spool directory" "creating"
When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
-.section "Testing"
+.section "Testing" "SECID34"
.cindex "testing" "installation"
Having installed Exim, you can check that the run time configuration file is
syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
production version.
-.section "Replacing another MTA with Exim"
+.section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
.cindex "replacing another MTA"
Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
-.cindex "FreeBSD" "MTA indirection"
+.cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
.cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
-.section "Upgrading Exim"
+.section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
.cindex "upgrading Exim"
If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
-.section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris"
+.section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
.cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
.code
The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
-.section "Setting options by program name"
+.section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
.cindex "&'mailq'&"
If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
were present before any other options.
&%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
.ilist
-.cindex "trusted user" "definition of"
+.cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
.cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
&%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
-.section "Command line options"
+.section "Command line options" "SECID39"
Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
no arguments.
+.vitem &%--version%&
+.oindex "&%--version%&"
+This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
+displayed.
+
.vitem &%-B%&<&'type'&>
.oindex "&%-B%&"
.cindex "8-bit characters"
.vitem &%-bd%&
.oindex "&%-bd%&"
.cindex "daemon"
-.cindex "SMTP listener"
+.cindex "SMTP" "listener"
.cindex "queue runner"
This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
message-specific values (such as &$sender_domain$&) are set, because no message
-is being processed &new("(but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&)").
+is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
&*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
-.new
.vitem &%-bem%&&~<&'filename'&>
.oindex "&%-bem%&"
.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
&$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
&%-be%&).
-.wen
.vitem &%-bF%&&~<&'filename'&>
.oindex "&%-bF%&"
When testing a filter file,
.cindex "&""From""& line"
.cindex "envelope sender"
-.cindex "&%-f%& option" "for filter testing"
+.oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
.vitem &%-bfd%&&~<&'domain'&>
.oindex "&%-bfd%&"
-.cindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
+.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
&$qualify_domain$&.
output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
-.new
Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
-plain text, are most easily tested using specialized SMTP test programs such as
+plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
+specialized SMTP test program such as
&url(http://jetmore.org/john/code/#swaks,swaks).
-.wen
.vitem &%-bhc%&&~<&'IP&~address'&>
.oindex "&%-bhc%&"
matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
option, which can be changed if necessary.
-The
-.cindex "&%-f%& option" "overriding &""From""& line"
-specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
+.oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
+The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
&%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
.vitem &%-bnq%&
.oindex "&%-bnq%&"
-.cindex "address qualification" "suppressing"
+.cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
.code
exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
.endd
+.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
+.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
+.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
users, the output is as in this example:
.cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
.cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
+.cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
that driver are output. For example:
settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
&%authenticators%&.
+.cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
+If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
+are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
+for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
+The output format is one item per line.
.vitem &%-bp%&
.oindex "&%-bp%&"
Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
the listening daemon.
+.vitem &%-bmalware%&&~<&'filename'&>
+.oindex "&%-bmalware%&"
+.cindex "testing", "malware"
+.cindex "malware scan test"
+This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file,
+using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
+this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
+the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
+not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
+will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
+
+Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
+using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
+user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
+This option requires admin privileges.
+
+The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
+there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
+administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
+
.vitem &%-bt%&
.oindex "&%-bt%&"
.cindex "testing" "addresses"
.cindex "address" "testing"
This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
-as an address to be tested for deliverability. The results are written to the
-standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no
-details of the failure are output, because these might contain sensitive
-information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
+as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
+written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
+user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
+sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
program.
-The
.cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
-return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
+The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
&*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
message,
-.cindex "&%-f%& option" "for address testing"
+.oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
&%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
.vitem &%-bV%&
.oindex "&%-bV%&"
-.cindex "version number of Exim" "verifying"
+.cindex "version number of Exim"
This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
It also lists the DBM library this is being used, the optional modules (such as
.cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
.cindex "address" "verification"
This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
-taken as an address to be verified by the routers. (This does not involve any
-verification callouts). During normal operation, verification happens mostly as
-a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL (see chapter
-&<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly including callouts,
-see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
+taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
+not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
+happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
+(see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
+including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
-.new
If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
-.wen
The
.cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
-When this option is used by a caller other than root or the Exim user, and the
-list is different from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege
-immediately, and runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of
-the caller. However, if ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is defined in
-&_Local/Makefile_&, root privilege is retained for &%-C%& only if the caller of
-Exim is root.
-
-That is, the Exim user is no longer privileged in this regard. This build-time
-option is not set by default in the Exim source distribution tarbundle.
-However, if you are using a &"packaged"& version of Exim (source or binary),
-the packagers might have enabled it.
-
-Setting ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY locks out the possibility of testing a
-configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery, even
-if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is running
-as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the delivery,
-the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception
-and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message on the queue,
-using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
+When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
+from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
+runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
+However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
+file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
+which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
+listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
+CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
+not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
+
+Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
+configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
+even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
+running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
+delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
+test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
+on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
+If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
+colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
+supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
+not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
+the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
+to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
+regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
+
The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
-filter files should be protected. &new("If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
+filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
-return code.")
+return code.
When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
turn everything off.
-.cindex "resolver" "debugging output"
-.cindex "DNS resolver" "debugging output"
+.cindex "resolver, debugging output"
+.cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
.oindex "&%-f%&"
.cindex "sender" "address"
.cindex "address" "sender"
-.cindex "trusted user"
+.cindex "trusted users"
.cindex "envelope sender"
.cindex "user" "trusted"
This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
.vitem &%-i%&
.oindex "&%-i%&"
.cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
-.cindex "dot in incoming" "non-SMTP message"
+.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. I can find
no documentation for this option in Solaris 2.4 Sendmail, but the &'mailx'&
only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
placed on the queue.
-.new
.vitem &%-Mset%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
.oindex "&%-Mset%&
.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
user. See also &%-bem%&.
-.wen
.vitem &%-Mt%&&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
.oindex "&%-Mt%&"
This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
+.vitem &%-Mvc%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
+.oindex "&%-Mvc%&"
+.cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
+.cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
+This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
+be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
+only by an admin user.
+
.vitem &%-Mvh%&&~<&'message&~id'&>
.oindex "&%-Mvh%&"
.cindex "listing" "message headers"
.vitem &%-oi%&
.oindex "&%-oi%&"
-.cindex "dot in incoming" "non-SMTP message"
+.cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
.vitem &%-oMa%&&~<&'host&~address'&>
.oindex "&%-oMa%&"
-.cindex "sender host address" "specifying for local message"
+.cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
.vitem &%-oMaa%&&~<&'name'&>
.oindex "&%-oMaa%&"
-.cindex "authentication name" "specifying for local message"
+.cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
.vitem &%-oMai%&&~<&'string'&>
.oindex "&%-oMai%&"
-.cindex "authentication id" "specifying for local message"
+.cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
.vitem &%-oMas%&&~<&'address'&>
.oindex "&%-oMas%&"
-.cindex "authentication sender" "specifying for local message"
+.cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
.vitem &%-oMi%&&~<&'interface&~address'&>
.oindex "&%-oMi%&"
-.cindex "interface address" "specifying for local message"
-.new
+.cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
&$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
-.wen
.vitem &%-oMr%&&~<&'protocol&~name'&>
.oindex "&%-oMr%&"
-.cindex "protocol" "incoming &-- specifying for local message"
-.cindex "&$received_protocol$&"
+.cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
+.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
&$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
.vitem &%-oMs%&&~<&'host&~name'&>
.oindex "&%-oMs%&"
-.cindex "sender host name" "specifying for local message"
+.cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
.vitem &%-oMt%&&~<&'ident&~string'&>
.oindex "&%-oMt%&"
-.cindex "sender ident string" "specifying for local message"
+.cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
.vitem &%-os%&&~<&'time'&>
.oindex "&%-os%&"
.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
-.cindex "SMTP timeout" "input"
+.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
-.new
If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
.code
This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
applied to each queue run.
-.wen
Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
.cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
.cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
The run time configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
-specified at compile time by the EXIM_USER option, or by the user that is
specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
-configuration file must not be world-writeable or group-writeable, unless its
-group is the one specified at compile time by the EXIM_GROUP option or by the
+configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
+group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
&*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
to root, anybody who is able to edit the run time configuration file has an
-easy way to run commands as root. If you make your mail administrators members
-of the Exim group, but do not trust them with root, make sure that the run time
-configuration is not group writeable.
+easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
+CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
+who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
+
+Up to Exim version 4.72, the run time configuration file was also permitted to
+be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
+since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
+compromise the Exim user account.
A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
-.section "Using a different configuration file"
+.section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
.cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
-&%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root or the
-Exim user (or unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value
-from CONFIGURE_FILE). &%-C%& is useful mainly for checking the syntax of
-configuration files before installing them. No owner or group checks are done
-on a configuration file specified by &%-C%&.
-
-The privileged use of &%-C%& by the Exim user can be locked out by setting
-ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. However,
-if you do this, you also lock out the possibility of testing a
-configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery, even
-if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is running
-as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the
-use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and
-delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message on the queue, using
-&%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
+&%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
+unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
+CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
+is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
+is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
+installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
+specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
+
+Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
+with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
+listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
+testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
+delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
+Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
+the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
+can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
+message on the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
+&%-M%&).
If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
+The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
+to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
+necessarily be discarded.
+WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
+considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
+values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
+is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
+transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
+values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
+
Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
optional parts are:
.ilist
-&'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail.
+&'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
+&<<CHAPACL>>&).
.next
.cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
&'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
.next
&'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
-addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered.
+addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
+&<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
.next
&'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
-define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations.
+define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
+&<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
.next
-&'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be immediately delivered.
+&'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
+If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
+defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
+are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
+&<<CHAPretry>>&.
.next
&'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
-when new addresses are generated during delivery.
+when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
+chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
.next
&'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
want to use this feature, you must set
.code
LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
.endd
-in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Full details of the
-&[local_scan()]& facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
+in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
+facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
.endlist
.cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
-.section "File inclusions in the configuration file"
+.section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
.cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
.cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
-.cindex ".include in configuration file"
-.cindex ".include_if_exists in configuration file"
+.cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
+.cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
You can include other files inside Exim's run time configuration file by
using this syntax:
.display
definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
-.section "Macro substitution"
+.section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
scanned for each in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
comment line or a &`.include`& line.
-.section "Redefining macros"
+.section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
(or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
&'='&. For example:
This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
from a number of other files.
-.section "Overriding macro values"
+.section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
&%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
-.section "Example of macro usage"
+.section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
.code
ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
- login=${quote_mysql:$local_part};
+ login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
.endd
This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
.code
section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
-.section "Conditional skips in the configuration file"
+.section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
.cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
-.cindex ".ifdef"
+.cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
&`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
.code
qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
.endd
+.cindex "hiding configuration option values"
+.cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
+.cindex "options" "hiding value of"
Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
that are found in option settings.
-.section "Boolean options"
+.section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
.cindex "format" "boolean"
.cindex "boolean configuration values"
.oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
-.section "Integer values"
+.section "Integer values" "SECID48"
.cindex "integer configuration values"
.cindex "format" "integer"
-If an integer data item starts with the characters &"0x"&, the remainder of it
-is interpreted as a hexadecimal number. Otherwise, it is treated as octal if it
-starts with the digit 0, and decimal if not. If an integer value is followed by
-the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if it is followed by the letter M, it
-is multiplied by 1024x1024.
-
-When the values of integer option settings are output, values which are an
-exact multiple of 1024 or 1024x1024 are
-sometimes, but not always,
-printed using the letters K and M. The printing style is independent of the
-actual input format that was used.
+If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
+hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
+number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
+with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
+hexadecimal number.
+
+If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
+it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024. When the values
+of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
+1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
+and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
+used.
-.section "Octal integer values"
+.section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
.cindex "integer format"
.cindex "format" "octal integer"
-The value of an option specified as an octal integer is always interpreted in
-octal, whether or not it starts with the digit zero. Such options are always
-output in octal.
-
+If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
+interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
+Such options are always output in octal.
-.section "Fixed point number values"
+.section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
.cindex "fixed point configuration values"
.cindex "format" "fixed point"
-A fixed point number consists of a decimal integer, optionally followed by a
-decimal point and up to three further digits.
+If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
+integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
-.section "Time interval values" "SECTtimeformat"
+.section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
.cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
.cindex "format" "time interval"
A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
the following letters, with no intervening white space:
-.table2 50pt
-.row &~&%s%& seconds
-.row &~&%m%& minutes
-.row &~&%h%& hours
-.row &~&%d%& days
-.row &~&%w%& weeks
+.table2 30pt
+.irow &%s%& seconds
+.irow &%m%& minutes
+.irow &%h%& hours
+.irow &%d%& days
+.irow &%w%& weeks
.endtable
For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
.section "String values" "SECTstrings"
.cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
.cindex "format" "string"
-If a string data item does not start with a double-quote character, it is taken
-as consisting of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines,
-starting at the first character after any leading white space, with trailing
-white space removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the
-string. Because Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early
-stage, they can appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following
-settings are therefore equivalent:
+If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
+or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
+consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
+the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
+removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
+Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
+appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
+therefore equivalent:
.code
trusted_users = uucp:mail
-
trusted_users = uucp:\
# This comment line is ignored
mail
continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
.table2 100pt
-.row &~&`\\`& "single backslash"
-.row &~&`\n`& "newline"
-.row &~&`\r`& "carriage return"
-.row &~&`\t`& "tab"
-.row "&~&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
-.row "&~&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
+.irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
+.irow &`\n`& "newline"
+.irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
+.irow &`\t`& "tab"
+.irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
+.irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
character"
.endtable
and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
-.section "Expanded strings"
-.cindex "string expansion" "definition of"
+.section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
.cindex "expansion" "definition of"
Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
within a quoted configuration string.
-.section "User and group names"
+.section "User and group names" "SECID52"
.cindex "user name" "format of"
.cindex "format" "user name"
-.cindex "group" "name format"
+.cindex "groups" "name format"
.cindex "format" "group name"
User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
.section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
.cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
.cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
-.cindex "string list" "definition"
+.cindex "string" "list, definition of"
The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
colon in the example above is necessary. If it were not there, the list would
be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
+.section "Changing list separators" "SECID53"
.cindex "list separator" "changing"
.cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
&%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
+.cindex "list separator" "newline as"
+.cindex "newline" "as list separator"
+It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
+code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
+must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
+are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
+sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
+interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
+generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
+.code
+domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
+.endd
+This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
+to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
+expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
+the value in quotes. For example:
+.code
+local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
+.endd
+Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
+doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
+set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
+enclosing an empty list item.
+
.section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
-.section "ACL configuration"
+.section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
.cindex "default" "ACLs"
.cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
-.section "Router configuration"
+.section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
.cindex "default" "routers"
.cindex "routers" "default"
The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
# local_part_suffix = +* : -*
# local_part_suffix_optional
.endd
-.cindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
+.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
-.section "Transport configuration"
+.section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
.cindex "default" "transports"
.cindex "transports" "default"
Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
-.section "Default retry rule"
+.section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
.cindex "retry" "default rule"
.cindex "default" "retry rule"
The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced.
+If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
+if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
+temporary errors into permanent errors.
-.section "Rewriting configuration"
+.section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
.code
begin rewrite
The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
.code
#PLAIN:
-# driver = plaintext
-# server_set_id = $auth2
-# server_prompts = :
-# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
+# driver = plaintext
+# server_set_id = $auth2
+# server_prompts = :
+# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
.endd
And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
.code
#LOGIN:
-# driver = plaintext
-# server_set_id = $auth1
-# server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
-# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
+# driver = plaintext
+# server_set_id = $auth1
+# server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
+# server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
# server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_cipher }
.endd
To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
expression like one of the examples in &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
+Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
+usercode and password are in different positions. &<<CHAPplaintext>>&
+covers both.
+
.ecindex IIDconfiwal
O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
-are supported by PCRE is included in plain text in the file
-&_doc/pcrepattern.txt_& in the Exim distribution, and also in the HTML
-tarbundle of Exim documentation. It describes in detail the features of the
-regular expressions that PCRE supports, so no further description is included
-here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using the default option settings
-(that is, with no PCRE options set), except that the PCRE_CASELESS option is
-set when the matching is required to be case-insensitive.
+are supported by PCRE is included in the PCRE distribution, and no further
+description is included here. The PCRE functions are called from Exim using
+the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE options set), except that
+the PCRE_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
+case-insensitive.
In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
-.section "Testing regular expressions"
-.cindex "testing" "regular expressions"
-.cindex "regular expressions" "testing"
-.cindex "&'pcretest'&"
-A program called &'pcretest'& forms part of the PCRE distribution and is built
-with PCRE during the process of building Exim. It is primarily intended for
-testing PCRE itself, but it can also be used for experimenting with regular
-expressions. After building Exim, the binary can be found in the build
-directory (it is not installed anywhere automatically). There is documentation
-of various options in &_doc/pcretest.txt_&, but for simple testing, none are
-needed. This is the output of a sample run of &'pcretest'&:
-.display
-&` re> `&&*&`/^([@]+)@.+\.(ac|edu)\.(?!kr)[a-z]{2}$/`&*&
-&`data> `&&*&`x@y.ac.uk`&*&
-&` 0: x@y.ac.uk`&
-&` 1: x`&
-&` 2: ac`&
-&`data> `&&*&`x@y.ac.kr`&*&
-&`No match`&
-&`data> `&&*&`x@y.edu.com`&*&
-&`No match`&
-&`data> `&&*&`x@y.edu.co`&*&
-&` 0: x@y.edu.co`&
-&` 1: x`&
-&` 2: edu`&
-.endd
-Input typed by the user is shown in bold face. After the &"re>"& prompt, a
-regular expression enclosed in delimiters is expected. If this compiles without
-error, &"data>"& prompts are given for strings against which the expression is
-matched. An empty data line causes a new regular expression to be read. If the
-match is successful, the captured substring values (that is, what would be in
-the variables &$0$&, &$1$&, &$2$&, etc.) are shown. The above example tests for
-an email address whose domain ends with either &"ac"& or &"edu"& followed by a
-two-character top-level domain that is not &"kr"&. The local part is captured
-in &$1$& and the &"ac"& or &"edu"& in &$2$&.
-
-
-
-
-
-
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
.chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
.scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
-.scindex IIDfidalo2 "database lookups"
+.scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
.cindex "lookup" "description of"
Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
-.section "Examples of different lookup syntax"
+.section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
lookup is permitted.
-.section "Lookup types"
+.section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
.cindex "lookup" "types of"
.cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
&(cdb)&: The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
-re-creation. As such, it is particulary suitable for large files containing
+re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb can
be found in several places:
.display
.next
.cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
.cindex "dsearch lookup type"
-&(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for a file
-whose name is the key. The key may not contain any forward slash characters.
-The result of a successful lookup is the name of the file. An example of how
-this lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
+&(dsearch)&: The given file must be a directory; this is searched for an entry
+whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function. The key may not
+contain any forward slash characters. If &[lstat()]& succeeds, the result of
+the lookup is the name of the entry, which may be a file, directory,
+symbolic link, or any other kind of directory entry. An example of how this
+lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
&<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
.next
.cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
.code
1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
-192.168.0.0/16 data for 192.168.0.0/16
+192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
"abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
"abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
.endd
.endlist ilist
-.section "Query-style lookup types"
+.section "Query-style lookup types" "SECID62"
.cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
.cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
.next
.cindex "whoson lookup type"
.cindex "lookup" "whoson"
-&(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a proposed
-Internet protocol that allows Internet server programs to check whether a
-particular (dynamically allocated) IP address is currently allocated to a known
-(trusted) user and, optionally, to obtain the identity of the said user. In
-Exim, this can be used to implement &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL
-statements such as
+&(whoson)&: &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
+allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
+address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
+obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
+at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
+superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
+&"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
.code
require condition = \
${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
-.section "Temporary errors in lookups"
+.section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
.cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
that is to be used if a lookup fails.
-.new
&*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
-.wen
If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
-.section "Lookup caching"
+.section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
.cindex "lookup" "caching"
.cindex "caching" "lookup data"
Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
-.section "Quoting lookup data"
+.section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
.cindex "lookup" "quoting"
.cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
white space is ignored.
-.section "Pseudo dnsdb record types"
+.cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
+For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
+unless a separator for them is specified using a comma after the separator
+character followed immediately by the TXT record item separator. To concatenate
+items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
+.code
+${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
+${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
+.endd
+It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
+white space is ignored.
+
+.section "Pseudo dnsdb record types" "SECID66"
.cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
returned.
-.cindex "name server" "for enclosing domain"
+.cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
-.section "Multiple dnsdb lookups"
+.section "Multiple dnsdb lookups" "SECID67"
In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
&(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
.section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
-.cindex "LDAP lookup"
+.cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
.cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
.cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
encrypted TLS connection is used.
-.section "LDAP quoting"
+.section "LDAP quoting" "SECID68"
.cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
authentication below.
-.section "LDAP connections"
+.section "LDAP connections" "SECID69"
.cindex "LDAP" "connections"
The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
failures, and timeouts.
For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
-of specifing a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
+of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
&%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
doubled. For example
.code
-.section "LDAP authentication and control information"
+.section "LDAP authentication and control information" "SECID70"
.cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
-.section "Format of data returned by LDAP"
+.section "Format of data returned by LDAP" "SECID71"
.cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
as a sequence of values, for example
.section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
.cindex "SQL lookup types"
+.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
+.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
+.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
+.cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
+.cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
+.cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
+.cindex "InterBase lookup type"
+.cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, and SQLite
databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
might be
with a newline between the data for each row.
-.section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase"
+.section "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, and InterBase" "SECID72"
.cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
.cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, or InterBase lookups are used, the
&%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, or &%ibase_servers%&
option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
-information. Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four items:
-host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of Oracle, the
-host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database name field
-is not used and should be empty. For example:
+information.
+(For MySQL and PostgreSQL only, the global option need not be set if all
+queries contain their own server information &-- see section
+&<<SECTspeserque>>&.) Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
+items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
+Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
+name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
.code
hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
.endd
.endd
For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
-query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection and a query
-succeeds.
+query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
+a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
+found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
+servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
for MySQL because these escapes are not recognized in contexts where these
characters are not special.
+.section "Specifying the server in the query" "SECTspeserque"
+For MySQL and PostgreSQL lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
+it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
+done by starting the query with
+.display
+&`servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&&`;`&
+.endd
+Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
+.olist
+If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
+global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
+of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
+taken from there.
+.next
+If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
+.endlist
+The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
+Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
+successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
+
+This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
+are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
+master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
+like this:
+.code
+mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
+ slave2/db/name/pw:\
+ master/db/name/pw
+.endd
+In an updating lookup, you could then write:
+.code
+${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
+.endd
+That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
+the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
+option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
+.code
+${lookup pgsql{servers=master/db/name/pw; UPDATE ...} }
+.endd
+
-.section "Special MySQL features"
+.section "Special MySQL features" "SECID73"
For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses. The full syntax of
is zero because no rows are affected.
-.section "Special PostgreSQL features"
+.section "Special PostgreSQL features" "SECID74"
PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
.section "More about SQLite" "SECTsqlite"
.cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
-.cindex "SQLite lookup type"
+.cindex "sqlite lookup type"
SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a file name is required in
addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
daemon as in the other SQL databases. The interface to Exim requires the name
-.section "Expansion of lists"
+.section "Expansion of lists" "SECID75"
.cindex "expansion" "of lists"
Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used. The result of
expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
-.section "Negated items in lists"
+.section "Negated items in lists" "SECID76"
.cindex "list" "negation"
.cindex "negation" "in lists"
Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
-.section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list"
+.section "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" "SECID77"
As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
-.section "Named lists compared with macros"
+.section "Named lists compared with macros" "SECID78"
.cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
.cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
.endd
-.section "Named list caching"
+.section "Named list caching" "SECID79"
.cindex "list" "caching of named"
.cindex "caching" "named lists"
While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
.ilist
.cindex "primary host name"
.cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
-.cindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
+.oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
.cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
.cindex "@ in a domain list"
If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
.cindex "@[] in a domain list"
.cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
.cindex "domain literal"
-If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches any local IP interface
-address, enclosed in square brackets, as in an email address that contains a
-domain literal.
+If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
+in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
+only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
+&%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
+control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial.
.next
.cindex "@mx_any"
.cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
-.cindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
+.oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
&%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
-References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions are given in
-chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
+Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
+default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
+with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
+are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
&*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
-.section "Special host list patterns"
+.section "Special host list patterns" "SECID80"
.cindex "empty item in hosts list"
.cindex "host list" "empty string in"
If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
-&"192.168.34.0/24"&. IPv6 addresses are converted to a text value using lower
-case letters and dots as separators instead of the more usual colon, because
-colon is the key terminator in &(lsearch)& files. Full, unabbreviated IPv6
+&"192.168.34.0/24"&.
+
+When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
+of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
+terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
+to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
+recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
+(notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
+For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
+converted using colons and not dots. In all cases, full, unabbreviated IPv6
addresses are always used.
-&*Warning*&: Specifing &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
-IPv6 address) is not the same as specifing just &%net-%& without a number. In
+Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
+colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
+However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
+configurations.
+
+&*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
+IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
case the IP address is used on its own.
By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
&[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
-are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option.
+are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
+security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
+for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
+Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
+discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
+found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
.cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
.cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
-matched against the host name. For example,
+matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
+expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
+case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
+syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
+example,
.code
^(a|b)\.c\.d$
.endd
.section "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" "SECTbehipnot"
-.cindex "host" "lookup failures"
+.cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
+&*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
+apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
+
.cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
.cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
By default, Exim behaves as if the host does not match the list. This may not
list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
list.
-&*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
-apply to temporary DNS errors. They always cause a defer action (except when
-&%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts them into permanent errors).
+
+.section "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
+ "SECTtemdnserr"
+.cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
+.cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
+.cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
+A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
+&%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
+host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analagous to
+&`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
+section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
+host lists such as whitelists.
.section "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
"SECThoslispatnamsk"
-.cindex "host" "lookup failures"
.cindex "unknown host name"
.cindex "host list" "matching host name"
If a pattern is of the form
.code
dbm;/host/accept/list
.endd
-a single-key lookup is performend, using the host name as its key. If the
+a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
is not used.
-.section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups"
+.section "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" "SECID81"
If a pattern is of the form
.display
<&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
-.section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings"
+.section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
.cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
-.section "Testing string expansions"
+.section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
.cindex "expansion" "testing"
.cindex "testing" "string expansion"
-.cindex "&%-be%& option"
+.oindex "&%-be%&"
Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
-.new
-.cindex "&%-bem%& option"
+.oindex "&%-bem%&"
If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a file name. The file is
.endd
This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
is therefore restricted to admin users.
-.wen
.section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
string easier to understand.
+.vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
+This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
+expansion item below.
+
.vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
.cindex &%dlfunc%&
.display
<&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
.endd
-.cindex "&$value$&"
+.vindex "&$value$&"
where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
empty (for example, the fifth field above).
+.vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
+.cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
+.cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
+.vindex "&$item$&"
+After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
+default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
+in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then the condition is
+evaluated. If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
+item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
+separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
+input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
+.code
+${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}
+.endd
+yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
+to what it was before. See also the &*map*& and &*reduce*& expansion items.
+
+
.vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
.cindex "hash function" "textual"
.cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
.endd
.vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
- &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
-See &*$rheader*& below.
-
-.vitem "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
- &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
-See &*$rheader*& below.
-
-.vitem "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
+ &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
+ "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
+ &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
+ "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
.cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
-.cindex "&$header_$&"
-.cindex "&$bheader_$&"
-.cindex "&$rheader_$&"
+.vindex "&$header_$&"
+.vindex "&$bheader_$&"
+.vindex "&$rheader_$&"
.cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
.cindex "header lines" "character sets"
.cindex "header lines" "decoding"
&'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
-.new
Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
point they are added. When a DATA ACL is running, however, header lines added
by earlier ACLs are visible.
-.wen
Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in section
&<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a header.)
-.new
If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
&%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
-.wen
.vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
.vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
-.cindex "&%length%&" "expansion item"
+.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
out by the system administrator.
-.cindex "&$value$&"
+.vindex "&$value$&"
If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
{$value}fail}
.endd
+
+.vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
+.cindex "expansion" "list creation"
+.vindex "&$item$&"
+After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
+default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way. For each item
+in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
+expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
+for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
+setting is not included in the output. For example:
+.code
+${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
+.endd
+expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
+value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &*filter*&
+and &*reduce*& expansion items.
+
.vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
.cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
.cindex "hash function" "numeric"
.vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
-.cindex "prvs" "expansion item"
+.cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
.vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
-.cindex "prvscheck" "expansion item"
+.cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
.vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
{*&<&'timeout'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
.cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
-.cindex "socket" "use of in expansion"
+.cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
.cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
This item inserts data from a Unix domain or Internet socket into the expanded
string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
-.vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:&~or&~$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
+
+.vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
+.cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
+.cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
+.vindex "&$value$&"
+.vindex "&$item$&"
+This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
+<&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
+separator can be changed in the usual way. Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
+assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
+list is assigned to &$item$& in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
+them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
+iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
+added to the expansion output. The &*reduce*& expansion item can be used in a
+number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
+.code
+${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
+.endd
+The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
+can be found:
+.code
+${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
+.endd
+At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
+restored to what they were before. See also the &*filter*& and &*map*&
+expansion items.
+
+.vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
expansion item above.
other command executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If you want
a shell, you must explicitly code it.
-.new
The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
-.cindex "&$value$&"
+.vindex "&$value$&"
If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
-.wen
-.cindex "&$runrc$&"
+.vindex "&$runrc$&"
The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
.code
.vitem &*${substr{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
-.cindex "&%substr%&"
+.cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
.cindex "substring extraction"
.cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
.vlist
.vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
-.cindex "&%address%&" "expansion item"
+.cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
not parse successfully, the result is empty.
+.vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
+.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
+.cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
+The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
+2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
+operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
+result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
+doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
+Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
+
+It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
+separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
+character. For example:
+.code
+${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
+.endd
+expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. Compare the &*address*& (singular)
+expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
+address. See the &*filter*&, &*map*&, and &*reduce*& items for ways of
+processing lists.
+
+
.vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
-.cindex "&%base62%&"
+.cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
.vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
-.cindex "&%base62d%&"
+.cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
.cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
.vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
.cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
-.cindex "&%escape%&, expansion item"
+.cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
.cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
.cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
.cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
-.new
These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
C programming language):
-.table2 90pt 300pt
-.row &~&~&~&~&~&~&~&~&'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
-.row "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
-.row "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
-.row "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
-.row "" "and (&&)"
-.row "" "xor (^)"
-.row &~&~&~&~&~&~&~&~&'lowest:'& "or (|)"
+.table2 70pt 300pt
+.irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
+.irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
+.irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
+.irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
+.irow "" "and (&&)"
+.irow "" "xor (^)"
+.irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
.endtable
Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
space is permitted before or after operators.
&`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
&`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
.endd
-.wen
As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
.code
.cindex "Unicode"
.cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
.cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
-.cindex "&%from_utf8%&"
+.cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
.vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
.cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
.cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
-.cindex "&%hex2b64%&"
+.cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
be useful for processing the output of the MD5 and SHA-1 hashing functions.
.vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
.cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
-.cindex "&%length%&" "expansion item"
+.cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
.cindex "IP address" "masking"
.cindex "CIDR notation"
.cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
-.cindex "&%mask%&, expansion item"
+.cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
.vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
.cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
.cindex "expansion" "quoting"
-.cindex "&%quote%&, expansion item"
+.cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
is an empty string or
contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
yields an unchanged string.
+.vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
+.cindex "random number"
+This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
+supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
+on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
+If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
+Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
+srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
+random().
+
+
+.vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
+.cindex "expansion" "IP address"
+This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
+dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addreses the result is in
+dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
+for DNS. For example,
+.code
+${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4} and ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.3}
+.endd
+returns
+.code
+4.2.0.192 and 3.0.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
+.endd
+
+
.vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
.cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
characters.
+.vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
+.cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
+.cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
+.cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
+This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
+bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
+character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
+not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
+
+&*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
+access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
+to use this operator as well.
+
+
.vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
.cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"& or &"M"& (in either upper or
lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024 or 1024*1024, respectively.
+As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
+zero.
+
+.vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
+.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
+.cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
+This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
+a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
+(case-insensitively); also positive integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
+false if zero. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
+All other string values will result in expansion failure.
+
+When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
+make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
+For example:
+.code
+${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
+.endd
+
+.vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
+.cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
+.cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
+Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
+where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
+loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
+and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
+true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
+
+Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
.vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
.cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
-.cindex "encrypted strings" "comparing"
+.cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
.cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
whatever its length.
.next
-.new
.cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
-&%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was orginally created to
+&%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
.endlist
determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
-.wen
.vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
.cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
&*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
-.vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
+.vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
+ &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
.cindex "string" "comparison"
.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
.cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
-The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
-resulting strings are identical, including the case of letters.
-
-.vitem &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
-.cindex "string" "comparison"
-.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
.cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
-resulting strings are identical when compared in a case-independent way.
+resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
+letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent.
.vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
.cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
-.vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
-.cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
-See &*gei*&.
-.vitem &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
+.vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
+ "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
+.cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
+.cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
+.cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
+.vindex "&$item$&"
+These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
+the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
+the normal method. The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
+be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
+condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
+.ilist
+For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
+the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
+items in the list, the overall condition is false.
+.next
+For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
+and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
+all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
+.endlist
+Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
+items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
+that the condition must be false for at least one item. In this example, the
+list separator is changed to a comma:
+.code
+${if forany{<, $recipients}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
+.endd
+The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &*forany*& or &*forall*& is
+being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
+
+
+.vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
+ &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
.cindex "string" "comparison"
.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
+.cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
.cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
-string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string: for &%ge%& the
+string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
case-independent.
-.vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
-.cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
-See &*gti*&.
-
-.vitem &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
+.vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
+ &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
.cindex "string" "comparison"
.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
+.cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
.cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
-string is lexically greater than the second string: for &%gt%& the comparison
+string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
case-independent.
-.vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
-.cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
-See &*isip6*&.
-
-.vitem &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
-.cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
-See &*isip6*&.
-
-.vitem &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
+.vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
+ &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
+ &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
.cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
.cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
+.cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
+.cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
.cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
-&%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test just for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses, respectively. For
-example, you could use
+&%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
+
+For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
+which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
+colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
+hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
+component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
+
+&*Note*&: The checks are just on the form of the address; actual numerical
+values are not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passes the IPv4
+check. The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
+host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
.code
${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
.endd
-to test which version of IP an incoming SMTP connection is using.
-
+to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
.vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
.cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
this can be used.
-.vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
-.cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
-See &*lei*&.
-
-.vitem &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
+.vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
+ &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
.cindex "string" "comparison"
.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
+.cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
.cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
-string is lexically less than or equal to the second string: for &%le%& the
+string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
case-independent.
-.vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
-.cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
-See &*lti*&.
-
-.vitem &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
+.vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
+ &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
.cindex "string" "comparison"
.cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
+.cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
.cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
-string is lexically less than the second string: for &%lt%& the comparison
+string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
case-independent.
.vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
.cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
.cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
-.cindex "&%match%&, expansion condition"
+.cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
in a single test such as
. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
-. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
+. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
+. ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
+. ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
.code
${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
.endd
.next
The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
.next
-Lookups are assumed to be &"net-"& style lookups, even if &`net-`& is not
-specified. Thus, the following are equivalent:
+Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists,
+even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
+address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
+&*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
+masks. For example:
+.code
+ ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
+.endd
+It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
+do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
+address mask, for example:
.code
- ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{lsearch;/some/file}...
- ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net-lsearch;/some/file}...
+ ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
.endd
-You do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a
-specific address mask, for example, by using &`net24-`&. However, unless you
-are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is usually neater to use
-an expansion lookup such as:
+However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
+just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
.code
- ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}lsearch{/some/file}...
+ ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
.endd
.endlist ilist
.vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
.cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
.cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
-.cindex "local part list" "in expansion condition"
+.cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
.cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
.code
server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
.endd
+Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
+.code
+server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
+.endd
.vitem &*queue_running*&
.cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
.cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
-.cindex "&%queue_runnint%& expansion condition"
+.cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
-.section "Combining expansion conditions"
+.section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
.cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
.section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
-.cindex "expansion variables" "list of"
+.cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
-processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item. They
-may also be set externally by some other matching process which precedes the
-expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in Exim filter
-files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression matching
-condition.
-
-.vitem "&$acl_c0$& &-- &$acl_c19$&"
-Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. The
-values persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be used
-to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the same
-ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved with
-the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during
-subsequent delivery.
-
-.vitem "&$acl_m0$& &-- &$acl_m19$&"
+processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
+However, they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
+values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
+variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
+precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
+Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
+matching condition.
+
+.vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
-retain their values while a message is being received, but are reset
-afterwards. They are also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a
-TLS session. When a message is received, the values of these variables are
-saved with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
+can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
+long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
+example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
+variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
+used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
+same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
+with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
during subsequent delivery.
+.vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
+These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
+are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
+received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
+message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
+also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
+message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
+and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
+delivery.
+
.vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
-.cindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
+.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers. The message can
be preserved by coding like this:
failure.
.vitem &$address_data$&
-.cindex "&$address_data$&"
+.vindex "&$address_data$&"
This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
.vitem &$address_file$&
-.cindex "&$address_file$&"
+.vindex "&$address_file$&"
When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
/home/r2d2/savemail
.endd
then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
-contains &"/home/r2d2/savemail"&.
-
+contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
.cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
to the relevant file.
.vitem &$address_pipe$&
-.cindex "&$address_pipe$&"
+.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
.vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth3$&"
-.cindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
+.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
&<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPspa>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
.vitem &$authenticated_id$&
.cindex "authentication" "id"
-.cindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
+.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
&$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
.cindex "sender" "authenticated"
.cindex "authentication" "sender"
.cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
-.cindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
+.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
-.cindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
+.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
.vitem &$authentication_failed$&
.cindex "authentication" "failure"
-.cindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
+.vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
.vitem &$body_linecount$&
.cindex "message body" "line count"
.cindex "body of message" "line count"
-.cindex "&$body_linecount$&"
+.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
.cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
.cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
-.cindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
+.vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
.vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
-.cindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
+.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
.vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
-.cindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
+.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
.vitem &$caller_gid$&
.cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
-.cindex "&$caller_gid$&"
+.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
&$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
.vitem &$caller_uid$&
.cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
-.cindex "&$caller_uid$&"
+.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
&$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
.vitem &$compile_date$&
-.cindex "&$compile_date$&"
+.vindex "&$compile_date$&"
The date on which the Exim binary was compiled.
.vitem &$compile_number$&
-.cindex "&$compile_number$&"
+.vindex "&$compile_number$&"
The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
compilations of the same version of the program.
.vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
-.cindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
+.vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
This variable is available when Exim is compiled with
the content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For
details, see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
.vitem &$demime_reason$&
-.cindex "&$demime_reason$&"
+.vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
-
-.vitem &$dnslist_domain$&
+.vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
+ &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
+ &$dnslist_text$& &&&
+ &$dnslist_value$&
+.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
+.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
+.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
+.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
.cindex "black list (DNS)"
-.cindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
-When a client host is found to be on a DNS (black) list,
-the list's domain name is put into this variable so that it can be included in
-the rejection message.
-
-.vitem &$dnslist_text$&
-.cindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
-When a client host is found to be on a DNS (black) list, the
-contents of any associated TXT record are placed in this variable.
-
-.vitem &$dnslist_value$&
-.cindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
-When a client host is found to be on a DNS (black) list,
-the IP address from the resource record is placed in this variable.
-If there are multiple records, all the addresses are included, comma-space
-separated.
+When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
+the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
+looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
+main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
.vitem &$domain$&
-.new
-.cindex "&$domain$&"
+.vindex "&$domain$&"
When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
case for &$domain$&.
-.wen
Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
&$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
-.cindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
+.oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
.next
.cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
-.cindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
+.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
.endlist
.vitem &$domain_data$&
-.cindex "&$domain_data$&"
+.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
When the &%domains%& option on a router matches a domain by
means of a lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running
of the router as &$domain_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the
to nothing.
.vitem &$exim_gid$&
-.cindex "&$exim_gid$&"
+.vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
.vitem &$exim_path$&
-.cindex "&$exim_path$&"
+.vindex "&$exim_path$&"
This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
.vitem &$exim_uid$&
-.cindex "&$exim_uid$&"
+.vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
.vitem &$found_extension$&
-.cindex "&$found_extension$&"
+.vindex "&$found_extension$&"
This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
content-scanning extension and the obsolete &%demime%& condition. For details,
see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
.vitem &$home$&
-.cindex "&$home$&"
+.vindex "&$home$&"
When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
of the environment variable HOME.
.vitem &$host$&
-.cindex "&$host$&"
+.vindex "&$host$&"
If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
.vitem &$host_address$&
-.cindex "&$host_address$&"
+.vindex "&$host_address$&"
This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
.vitem &$host_data$&
-.cindex "&$host_data$&"
+.vindex "&$host_data$&"
If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
allows you, for example, to do things like this:
message = $host_data
.endd
.vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
-.cindex "host name lookup" "failure of"
-.cindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
+.cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
+.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
&"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
.vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
-.cindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
+.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
.vitem &$inode$&
-.cindex "&$inode$&"
+.vindex "&$inode$&"
The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
a unique name for the file.
-.new
.vitem &$interface_address$&
-.cindex "&$interface_address$&"
+.vindex "&$interface_address$&"
This is an obsolete name for &$received_ip_address$&.
.vitem &$interface_port$&
-.cindex "&$interface_port$&"
+.vindex "&$interface_port$&"
This is an obsolete name for &$received_port$&.
-.wen
+
+.vitem &$item$&
+.vindex "&$item$&"
+This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
+conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
+&*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
+empty.
.vitem &$ldap_dn$&
-.cindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
+.vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
lookup.
.vitem &$load_average$&
-.cindex "&$load_average$&"
-This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 to that it
+.vindex "&$load_average$&"
+This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
.vitem &$local_part$&
-.cindex "&$local_part$&"
+.vindex "&$local_part$&"
When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
once.
-.cindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
-.cindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
+.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
+.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
&%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
.vitem &$local_part_data$&
-.cindex "&$local_part_data$&"
+.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
When the &%local_parts%& option on a router matches a local part by means of a
lookup, the data read by the lookup is available during the running of the
router as &$local_part_data$&. In addition, if the driver routes the address
variable expands to nothing.
.vitem &$local_part_prefix$&
-.cindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
+.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
specific prefix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
.vitem &$local_part_suffix$&
-.cindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
+.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
When an address is being routed or delivered, and a
specific suffix for the local part was recognized, it is available in this
variable, having been removed from &$local_part$&.
.vitem &$local_scan_data$&
-.cindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
+.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
.vitem &$local_user_gid$&
-.cindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
+.vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
See &$local_user_uid$&.
.vitem &$local_user_uid$&
-.cindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
+.vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
&%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
.vitem &$localhost_number$&
-.cindex "&$localhost_number$&"
+.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
This contains the expanded value of the
&%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
been read.
.vitem &$log_inodes$&
-.cindex "&$log_inodes$&"
+.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
.vitem &$log_space$&
-.cindex "&$log_space$&"
+.vindex "&$log_space$&"
The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
.vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
-.cindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
+.vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
&(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
&%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
variable is empty.
.vitem &$malware_name$&
-.cindex "&$malware_name$&"
+.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
+.vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
+.vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
+.cindex "maximum" "line length"
+.cindex "line length" "maximum"
+This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
+received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
+character(s).
.vitem &$message_age$&
.cindex "message" "age of"
-.cindex "&$message_age$&"
+.vindex "&$message_age$&"
This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
delivery attempt.
.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
.cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
-.cindex "&$message_body$&"
-This variable contains the initial portion of a message's
-body while it is being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter
-files. The maximum number of characters of the body that are put into the
-variable is set by the &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the
-default is 500. Newlines are converted into spaces to make it easier to search
-for phrases that might be split over a line break.
-Binary zeros are also converted into spaces.
+.vindex "&$message_body$&"
+.oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
+This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
+being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
+number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
+&%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
+
+.oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
+By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
+easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
+this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
+zeros are always converted into spaces.
.vitem &$message_body_end$&
.cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
.cindex "message body" "in expansion"
-.cindex "&$message_body_end$&"
+.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
This variable contains the final portion of a message's
body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
&$message_body$&.
.vitem &$message_body_size$&
.cindex "body of message" "size"
.cindex "message body" "size"
-.cindex "&$message_body_size$&"
+.vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
.vitem &$message_exim_id$&
-.cindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
+.vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
&`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
.vitem &$message_headers$&
-.new
-.cindex &$message_headers$&
+.vindex &$message_headers$&
This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
.vitem &$message_headers_raw$&
-.cindex &$message_headers_raw$&
+.vindex &$message_headers_raw$&
This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
contents of header lines is done.
-.wen
.vitem &$message_id$&
This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&, which is now deprecated.
.vitem &$message_linecount$&
-.cindex "&$message_linecount$&"
+.vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
.code
deny message = Too many lines in message header
condition = \
- ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
+ ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
.endd
In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
message has not yet been received.
.vitem &$message_size$&
.cindex "size" "of message"
.cindex "message" "size"
-.cindex "&$message_size$&"
+.vindex "&$message_size$&"
When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
&$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
.cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
-While running an ACL at the time of an SMTP RCPT command, &$message_size$&
+While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
value may not, of course, be truthful.
of the &%add%& command in filter files.
.vitem &$original_domain$&
-.cindex "&$domain$&"
-.cindex "&$original_domain$&"
+.vindex "&$domain$&"
+.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
.vitem &$original_local_part$&
-.cindex "&$local_part$&"
-.cindex "&$original_local_part$&"
+.vindex "&$local_part$&"
+.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
.vitem &$originator_gid$&
.cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
.cindex "sender" "gid"
-.cindex "&$caller_gid$&"
-.cindex "&$originator_gid$&"
+.vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
+.vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
.vitem &$originator_uid$&
.cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
.cindex "sender" "uid"
-.cindex "&$caller_uid$&"
-.cindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
+.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
+.vindex "&$originaltor_uid$&"
The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
user.
.vitem &$parent_domain$&
-.cindex "&$parent_domain$&"
+.vindex "&$parent_domain$&"
This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
.vitem &$parent_local_part$&
-.cindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
+.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
(see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
.vitem &$pid$&
.cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
-.cindex "&$pid$&"
+.vindex "&$pid$&"
This variable contains the current process id.
.vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
.cindex "transport" "filter"
-.cindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
+.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
&`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
&(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
variable"& error if encountered.
.vitem &$primary_hostname$&
-.cindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
+.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
&<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
.vitem &$qualify_domain$&
-.cindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
+.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
.vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
-.cindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
+.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
.vitem &$rcpt_count$&
-.cindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
+.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
.vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
-.cindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
+.vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
.vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
-.cindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
+.vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
.vitem &$received_count$&
-.cindex "&$received_count$&"
+.vindex "&$received_count$&"
This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
delivering.
.vitem &$received_for$&
-.cindex "&$received_for$&"
+.vindex "&$received_for$&"
If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
-.new
.vitem &$received_ip_address$&
-.cindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
+.vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, this
variable is set to the address of the local IP interface, and &$received_port$&
is set to the local port number. (The remote IP address and port are in
&(smtp)& transport).
.vitem &$received_port$&
-.cindex "&$received_port$&"
+.vindex "&$received_port$&"
See &$received_ip_address$&.
-.wen
.vitem &$received_protocol$&
-.cindex "&$received_protocol$&"
+.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
.vitem &$received_time$&
-.cindex "&$received_time$&"
+.vindex "&$received_time$&"
This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
.vitem &$recipient_data$&
-.cindex "&$recipient_data$&"
+.vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
.vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
-.cindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
+.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
.vitem &$recipients$&
-.cindex "&$recipients$&"
-This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a
-message. A comma and a space separate the addresses in the replacement text.
-However, the variable is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc
-recipients in unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only
-in these two cases:
+.vindex "&$recipients$&"
+This variable contains a list of envelope recipients for a message. A comma and
+a space separate the addresses in the replacement text. However, the variable
+is not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
+unprivileged users' filter files. You can use &$recipients$& only in these
+cases:
.olist
In a system filter file.
is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
&%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
+.next
+From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
.endlist
.vitem &$recipients_count$&
-.cindex "&$recipients_count$&"
+.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
.vitem &$regex_match_string$&
-.cindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
+.vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
&%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
.vitem &$reply_address$&
-.cindex "&$reply_address$&"
+.vindex "&$reply_address$&"
When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
&'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
decoding or character code translation takes place.
.vitem &$return_path$&
-.cindex "&$return_path$&"
+.vindex "&$return_path$&"
When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
envelope sender.
.vitem &$return_size_limit$&
-.cindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
+.vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
.vitem &$runrc$&
.cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
-.cindex "&$runrc$&"
+.vindex "&$runrc$&"
This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
&%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
another.
.vitem &$self_hostname$&
-.cindex "&%self%& option" "value of host name"
-.cindex "&$self_hostname$&"
+.oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
+.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
.vitem &$sender_address$&
-.new
-.cindex "&$sender_address$&"
+.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
-.wen
.vitem &$sender_address_data$&
-.cindex "&$address_data$&"
-.cindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
+.vindex "&$address_data$&"
+.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
.vitem &$sender_address_domain$&
-.cindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
+.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
.vitem &$sender_address_local_part$&
-.cindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
+.vindex "&$sender_address_local_part$&"
The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
.vitem &$sender_data$&
-.cindex "&$sender_data$&"
+.vindex "&$sender_data$&"
This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
.vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
-.cindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
+.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
.vitem &$sender_helo_name$&
-.cindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
+.vindex "&$sender_helo_name$&"
When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
.vitem &$sender_host_address$&
-.cindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
+.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains that
host's IP address. For locally submitted messages, it is empty.
.vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
-.cindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
+.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
&$authenticated_id$&.
.vitem &$sender_host_name$&
-.cindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
+.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
other means, this variable is empty.
-.cindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
+.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
&$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
&$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
-.cindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
+.vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
&$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
.vitem &$sender_host_port$&
-.cindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
+.vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
number that was used on the remote host.
.vitem &$sender_ident$&
-.cindex "&$sender_ident$&"
+.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
.vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
.cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
.cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
-.cindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
+.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
.vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
-.cindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
+.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
about the failure. The details are the same as for
&$recipient_verify_failure$&.
+.vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
+.vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
+This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
+been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
+used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
+on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
+connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
+
+.vitem &$sending_port$&
+.vindex "&$sending_port$&"
+This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
+been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
+connections, see &$received_port$&.
+
.vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
-.cindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
+.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
&$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
.vitem &$smtp_command$&
-.cindex "&$smtp_command$&"
+.vindex "&$smtp_command$&"
During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
.vitem &$smtp_command_argument$&
-.cindex "SMTP command" "argument for"
-.cindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
+.cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
+.vindex "&$smtp_command_argument$&"
While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
+.vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
+.vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
+This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
+daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
+in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
+connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
+the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
+never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
+there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
+single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
+daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
+
.vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
.vitem &$spool_directory$&
-.cindex "&$spool_directory$&"
+.vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
The name of Exim's spool directory.
.vitem &$spool_inodes$&
-.cindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
+.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
.vitem &$spool_space$&
-.cindex "&$spool_space$&"
+.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
.vitem &$thisaddress$&
-.cindex "&$thisaddress$&"
+.vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
interfaces to mail filtering'&.
.vitem &$tls_certificate_verified$&
-.cindex "&$tls_certificate_verified$&"
+.vindex "&$tls_certificate_verified$&"
This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
.vitem &$tls_cipher$&
-.cindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
+.vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
-received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. See chapter
-&<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support.
+received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
+&$tls_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
+non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
+
+The &$tls_cipher$& variable retains its value during message delivery, except
+when an outward SMTP delivery takes place via the &(smtp)& transport. In this
+case, &$tls_cipher$& is cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
+and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
+&<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
+details of the &(smtp)& transport.
.vitem &$tls_peerdn$&
-.cindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
+.vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
-&$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
+&$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing. Like &$tls_cipher$&, the
+value is retained during message delivery, except during outbound SMTP
+deliveries.
.vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
-.cindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
+.vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
.vitem &$tod_epoch$&
-.cindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
+.vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
.vitem &$tod_full$&
-.cindex "&$tod_full$&"
+.vindex "&$tod_full$&"
A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
+0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
values for those that are behind (west).
.vitem &$tod_log$&
-.cindex "&$tod_log$&"
+.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
.vitem &$tod_logfile$&
-.cindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
+.vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
flag.
.vitem &$tod_zone$&
-.cindex "&$tod_zone$&"
+.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
-0500.
.vitem &$tod_zulu$&
-.cindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
+.vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
.vitem &$value$&
-.cindex "&$value$&"
+.vindex "&$value$&"
This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
-or external command, as described above.
+or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
+&*reduce*& expansion.
.vitem &$version_number$&
-.cindex "&$version_number$&"
+.vindex "&$version_number$&"
The version number of Exim.
.vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
-.cindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
+.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
.vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
-.cindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
+.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
.endlist
in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
-.section "Setting up so Perl can be used"
-.cindex "&%perl_startup%&"
+.section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
+.oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
&%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
two ways:
.ilist
-.cindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
+.oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
a startup when Exim is entered.
.next
initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
-.section "Calling Perl subroutines"
+.section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
that was passed to &%die%&.
-.section "Calling Exim functions from Perl"
+.section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
the Perl code
timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
-.section "Use of standard output and error by Perl"
+.section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
.cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
chapter describes how they operate.
-.new
When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
-.wen
-.section "Starting a listening daemon"
+.section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
following options:
-.section "Special IP listening addresses"
+.section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
-.section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports"
+.section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
&%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
-.section "IPv6 address scopes"
+.section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
.cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
&[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
-.section "Disabling IPv6"
+.section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
-.section "Examples of starting a listening daemon"
+.section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
The default case in an IPv6 environment is
.code
daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
-.section "Recognising the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
+.section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
-.section "Delivering to a remote host"
+.section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
listed in more than one group.
-.section "Miscellaneous"
+.section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
.table2
.row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
.row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
.row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
+.row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
.row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
.row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
.row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
.endtable
-.section "Exim parameters"
+.section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
.table2
.row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
.row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
-.section "Privilege controls"
+.section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
.table2
.row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
.row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
-.section "Logging"
+.section "Logging" "SECID99"
.table2
.row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
.row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
-.section "Frozen messages"
+.section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
.table2
.row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
.row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
-.section "Data lookups"
+.section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
.table2
+.row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
.row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
.row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
.row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
-.row &%mysql_servers%& "as it says"
-.row &%oracle_servers%& "as it says"
-.row &%pgsql_servers%& "as it says"
+.row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
+.row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
+.row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
.row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
.endtable
-.section "Message ids"
+.section "Message ids" "SECID102"
.table2
.row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
.row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
-.section "Embedded Perl Startup"
+.section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
.table2
.row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
.row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
-.section "Daemon"
+.section "Daemon" "SECID104"
.table2
.row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
.row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
-.section "Resource control"
+.section "Resource control" "SECID105"
.table2
.row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
.row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
.row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
.row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
.row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
+.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
.row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
.row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
.row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
-.section "Policy controls"
+.section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
.table2
.row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
.row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
.row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
.row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
.row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
+.row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
.row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
.row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
.row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
-.section "Callout cache"
+.section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
.table2
.row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
item"
-.section "TLS"
+.section "TLS" "SECID108"
.table2
+.row &%gnutls_require_kx%& "control GnuTLS key exchanges"
+.row &%gnutls_require_mac%& "control GnuTLS MAC algorithms"
+.row &%gnutls_require_protocols%& "control GnuTLS protocols"
+.row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
+.row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
.row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
.row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
.row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
.row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
.row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
.row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
-.row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable cipers"
+.row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
.row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
.row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
.row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
-.section "Local user handling"
+.section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
.table2
.row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
.row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
-.section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)"
+.section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
.table2
.row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
.row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
.row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
.row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
.row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
-.row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess"
+.row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
.endtable
-.section "Non-SMTP incoming messages"
+.section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
.table2
.row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
.endtable
-.section "Incoming SMTP messages"
+.section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
.table2
-.section "SMTP extensions"
+.section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
.table2
.row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
.row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
-.section "Processing messages"
+.section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
.table2
.row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
.row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
-.section "System filter"
+.section "System filter" "SECID115"
.table2
.row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
.row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
-.section "Routing and delivery"
+.section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
.table2
.row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
.row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
.row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
.row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
.row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
+.row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
.row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
.row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
.row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
-.section "Bounce and warning messages"
+.section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
.table2
.row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
.row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
.row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
.row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
.row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
+.row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
.row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
.row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
.row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
.cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
-acknowledgement is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
+acknowledgment is sent. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
.option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
.cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
further details.
.option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
-.cindex "QUIT" "ACL for"
+.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
.option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
-.cindex "STARTTLS" "ACL for"
+.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
.code
auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{}{*}}
.endd
-.cindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
+.vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
If &$tls_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
.code
sophie:/var/run/sophie
.endd
-If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with dollar character, it is expanded
+If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
.option bi_command main string unset
-.cindex "&%-bi%& option"
+.oindex "&%-bi%&"
This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
.option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
-.cindex "size limit" "of bounce"
+.cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
.cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
.cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
.oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
.cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
-.option check_rfc2047_length " User: main" boolean true
+.option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
.option check_spool_space main integer 0
.cindex "checking disk space"
-.cindex "disk space" "checking"
+.cindex "disk space, checking"
.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
message is accepted.
-.cindex "&$log_inodes$&"
-.cindex "&$log_space$&"
-.cindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
-.cindex "&$spool_space$&"
+.vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
+.vindex "&$log_space$&"
+.vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
+.vindex "&$spool_space$&"
When any of these options are set, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
.option daemon_startup_retries main integer 9
-.cindex "daemon startup" "retrying"
+.cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
This option, along with &%daemon_startup_sleep%&, controls the retrying done by
the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
(typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
.option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
.cindex "warning of delay"
-.cindex "delay warning" "specifying"
+.cindex "delay warning, specifying"
When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
.endd
.option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
-.cindex "&$domain$&"
+.vindex "&$domain$&"
The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
+.option disable_fsync main boolean false
+.cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
+This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
+ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
+a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
+build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
+really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
+distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
+
+When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
+updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
+such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
+Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
+
.option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
.cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
(?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
.endd
which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
-they must start and end with a letter or digit. Hyphens are not, in fact,
+they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
&%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
+.option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
+.cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
+.cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
+This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
+bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
+Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
+.code
+dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
+.endd
+The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
+panic is logged, and the default value is used.
.option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
postmaster@mydomain.example
.endd
-.cindex "&$domain$&"
-.cindex "&$local_part$&"
+.vindex "&$domain$&"
+.vindex "&$local_part$&"
The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
.option exim_path main string "see below"
-.cindex "Exim binary" "path name"
+.cindex "Exim binary, path name"
This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
&<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
-.option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~arguments" main boolean true
-.cindex "&%-t%& option"
+. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
+. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
+
+.option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments" main boolean true &&&
+ extract_addresses_remove_arguments
+.oindex "&%-t%&"
.cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
.option finduser_retries main integer 0
-.cindex "NIS" "looking up users; retrying"
+.cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
.option gecos_name main string&!! unset
.cindex "HP-UX"
-.cindex "&""gecos""& field" "parsing"
+.cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
See &%gecos_name%& above.
+.option gnutls_require_kx main string unset
+This option controls the key exchange mechanisms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
+server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
+
+.option gnutls_require_mac main string unset
+This option controls the MAC algorithms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
+server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
+
+.option gnutls_require_protocols main string unset
+This option controls the protocols when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
+server. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
+
+.option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
+This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
+server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
+implementations of TLS.
+
.option headers_charset main string "see below"
This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
&"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
.option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
.cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
-.cindex "EHLO verifying" "optional"
+.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
&%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
-condition &`verify`& &`=`& &`helo`& is provided to make this possible.
+condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
-necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify`& &`=`& &`helo`& is
+necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
-be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify`& &`=`& &`helo`& condition.
+be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
.option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
.cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
-.cindex "EHLO verifying" "mandatory"
+.cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
.option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
-.cindex "host name lookup" "forcing"
+.cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
-.cindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
-.cindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
+.vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
+.vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
-&%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and &`verify`& &`=`&
-&`reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
+&%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
+&`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
.option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
&(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
-interfaces and recognising the local host.
+interfaces and recognizing the local host.
+
+
+.option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
+.cindex "InterBase" "server list"
+This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
+to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
+The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
+
.option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
.option ldap_version main integer unset
-.cindex "LDAP protocol version" "forcing"
+.cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
-1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
.option localhost_number main string&!! unset
.cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
.cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
-.cindex "&$localhost_number$&"
+.vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
uniqueness among a set of hosts is required, each host must set a different
value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
.option log_timezone main boolean false
.cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
-.cindex "&$tod_log$&"
-.cindex "&$tod_zone$&"
+.vindex "&$tod_log$&"
+.vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
.option lookup_open_max main integer 25
.cindex "too many open files"
-.cindex "open files" "too many"
+.cindex "open files, too many"
.cindex "file" "too many open"
.cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
.cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
.option max_username_length main integer 0
-.cindex "length" "of login name"
+.cindex "length of login name"
.cindex "user name" "maximum length"
.cindex "limit" "user name length"
Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
+.option message_body_newlines main bool false
+.cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
+.cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
+.vindex "&$message_body$&"
+.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
+By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
+the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
+option is set true, this no longer happens.
+
.option message_body_visible main integer 500
.cindex "body of message" "visible size"
.cindex "message body" "visible size"
-.cindex "&$message_body$&"
-.cindex "&$message_body_end$&"
+.vindex "&$message_body$&"
+.vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
&$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
.option message_logs main boolean true
-.cindex "message log" "disabling"
+.cindex "message logs" "disabling"
.cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
&_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
.option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
.cindex "message" "size limit"
.cindex "limit" "message size"
-.cindex "size of message" "limit"
+.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
-value is expanded for each incoming
-connection so, for example, it can be made to depend on the IP address of the
-remote host for messages arriving via TCP/IP. &*Note*&: This limit cannot be
-made to depend on a message's sender or any other properties of an individual
-message, because it has to be advertised in the server's response to EHLO.
-String expansion failure causes a temporary error. A value of zero means no
-limit, but its use is not recommended. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
+value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
+to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
+TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
+optionally followed by K or M.
+
+&*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
+other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
+the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
+error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
+&%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
message that an individual transport can process.
+If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
+maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
+failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
+virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
+probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. Eg, with a
+default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
+some problems may result.
+
.option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
.cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
.option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
.cindex "MySQL" "server list"
This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
-be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECTsql>>&). The
+be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
transport driver.
+.option openssl_options main "string list" +dont_insert_empty_fragments
+.cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
+This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
+by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
+each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value. The default
+value is one option which happens to have been set historically. You can
+remove all options with:
+.code
+openssl_options = -all
+.endd
+This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
+available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
+The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
+the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
+list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
+&"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
+names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
+
+Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
+SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
+yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
+adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at by invoking Exim
+with the &%-bV%& flag.
+
+An example:
+.code
+openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer
+.endd
+
+
.option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
.cindex "Oracle" "server list"
This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
-to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECTsql>>&).
+to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
.cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
-&<<SECTsql>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
+&<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
PostgreSQL support.
.option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
.cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
-.cindex "pid file" "path for"
+.cindex "pid file, path for"
This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
to the host name:
.option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
-.cindex "PIPELINING advertising" "suppressing"
+.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
-PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. When PIPELINING is not
-advertised and &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict
-synchronization for each SMTP command and response.
-When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes that clients will use it; &"out
-of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do not count as protocol errors (see
-&%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
+PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
+control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
+&%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
+for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
+that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
+not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
.option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
.cindex "name" "of local host"
.cindex "host" "name of local"
.cindex "local host" "name of"
-.cindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
+.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
.option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
-.cindex "&%-M%& option"
-.cindex "&%-R%& option"
-.cindex "&%-q%& option"
+.oindex "&%-M%&"
+.oindex "&%-R%&"
+.oindex "&%-q%&"
The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
&%queue_list_requires_admin%&.
.option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
-.cindex "&%-bp%& option"
+.oindex "&%-bp%&"
The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
&%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false. See also &%prod_requires_admin%&.
This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
-each path that exists, the corresponding queuing option is set.
+each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
&"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
.code
.cindex "message" "queueing by load"
If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
-happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages on the same
-connection are queued. Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue
-runner processes. This option has no effect on ancient operating systems on
-which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
-&%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
+happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
+the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
+the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
+false.
+
+Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
+option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
+determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
+&%smtp_load_reserve%&.
+
+
+.option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
+.cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
+When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
+because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
+all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
+This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
+threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
+connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
+circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
+where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
+should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
+re-evaluated for each message.
.option queue_only_override main boolean true
If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
&%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
-doing the SMTP routing before queuing, so that several messages for the same
+doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
-other end of the connection should send an acknowledgement if the connection is
+other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
-set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%&.
+set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
+A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
+has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
+that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
+and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
.option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
-but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurence of HELO
+but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
live with.
+. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
+. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
-.option smtp_accept_max_per_connection main integer 1000
-.cindex "SMTP incoming message count" "limiting"
+.option "smtp_accept_max_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 1000 &&&
+ smtp_accept_max_per_connection
+.cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
.cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
-connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. The
-default value of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set, it is required
-that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
+connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
+is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
+of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
+required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
&*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
.cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
.cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
-If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls handled via the listening
-daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed on the
-queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. A value of zero implies
-no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only if it is less than the
-&%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See also &%queue_only%&,
-&%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the various &%-od%&&'x'&
-command line options.
+If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
+listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
+on the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
+fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
+subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
+to all messages received in the same connection.
+
+A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
+if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
+also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
+various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
-.option smtp_accept_queue_per_connection main integer 10
+. Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
+. for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
+
+.option "smtp_accept_queue_per_ &~&~connection" main integer 10 &&&
+ smtp_accept_queue_per_connection
.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
.cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
&%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
-of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that that group
-of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections.
+of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
+of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
+the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
+individual host.
For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
-connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
-See also &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&.
+connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
+provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
.option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
-.new
.cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
.cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
-.cindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
+.vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
incoming HELO or EHLO command.
-.cindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
+.vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
&%helo_data%& value.
-.wen
.option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
.cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
.option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
.cindex "checking disk space"
-.cindex "disk space" "checking"
+.cindex "disk space, checking"
.cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
.option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
.cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
-.cindex "&$domain$&"
+.vindex "&$domain$&"
If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
.option smtp_receive_timeout main time 5m
.cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
-.cindex "SMTP timeout" "input"
+.cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
-.cindex "&%-os%& option"
+.oindex "&%-os%&"
The value set by this option can be overridden by the
&%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
.option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
.cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
-.cindex "policy control rejection" "returning details"
+.cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
&"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
-to spammers. However, some other syadmins who are applying strict checking
+to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
&%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
.option split_spool_directory main boolean false
.cindex "multiple spool directories"
.cindex "spool directory" "split"
-.cindex "directories" "multiple"
+.cindex "directories, multiple"
If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
.option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
-.cindex "sqlite" "lock timeout"
+.cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
-.new
.option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
-.cindex "ACL variables" "handling unset"
+.cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
&<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
-.wen
.option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
-.cindex "angle brackets" "excess"
+.cindex "angle brackets, excess"
If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
.option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
-.cindex "&$address_file$&"
+.vindex "&$address_file$&"
This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
&%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
.option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
-.cindex "&$address_pipe$&"
+.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
contains the pipe command.
.option system_filter_user main string unset
.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
-If this option is not set, the system filter is run in the main Exim delivery
-process, as root. When the option is set, the system filter runs in a separate
-process, as the given user. Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
+If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
+delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
+process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
+Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
-transport option overrides. Normally you should set &%system_filter_user%& if
-your system filter generates these kinds of delivery.
+transport option overrides.
.option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
-.new
&*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
frozen messages remain on the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
-.wen
.option timezone main string unset
-.cindex "timezone" "setting"
+.cindex "timezone, setting"
The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
.option tls_certificate main string&!! unset
.cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
-.cindex "certificate for server" "location of"
+.cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
The value of this option is expanded, and must then be the absolute path to a
file which contains the server's certificates. The server's private key is also
assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
-certificates from clients.
-The expected certificates are defined by &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which
-must be set. A configuration error occurs if either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
-&%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
+certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
+&%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
+either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
+&%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
-&%tls_verify_certificates%&. The client must present one of the listed
-certificates. If it does not, the connection is aborted.
+&%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
+present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
+aborted. &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
+the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
+connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
+ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
.option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
-.cindex "trusted group"
-.cindex "group" "trusted"
+.cindex "trusted groups"
+.cindex "groups" "trusted"
This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
are trusted.
.option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
-.cindex "trusted user"
+.cindex "trusted users"
.cindex "user" "trusted"
This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
.option unknown_login main string&!! unset
.cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
-.cindex "&$caller_uid$&"
+.vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
See &%unknown_login%&.
.option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
-.cindex "trusted user"
+.cindex "trusted users"
.cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
-.cindex "untrusted user" "setting sender"
+.cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
.cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
.cindex "envelope sender"
When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
.code
exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
.endd
-.cindex "&$sender_ident$&"
+.vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
&%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
delivery of the address to be deferred.
-.cindex "&$address_data$&"
+.vindex "&$address_data$&"
When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
routers, and the eventual transport.
This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
+.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
+.vindex "&$address_data$&"
The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
-
-.cindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
-.cindex "&$address_data$&"
-When &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address
-from an ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement.
-After verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
-
+&$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
+ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
+verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
.option address_test routers&!? boolean true
-.cindex "&%-bt%& option"
+.oindex "&%-bt%&"
.cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
more details.
-.cindex "&$local_part$&"
-.cindex "&$original_local_part$&"
-.cindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
+.vindex "&$local_part$&"
+.vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
+.vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
.option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
-.cindex "local user" "checking in router"
+.cindex "local user, checking in router"
.cindex "router" "checking for local user"
.cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
-.cindex "&$home$&"
+.vindex "&$home$&"
When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
+This option is unique in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
+All &%condition%& options must succeed.
+
The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
.code
condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
.endd
+A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
+.code
+condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
+condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
+condition = foobar
+.endd
If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
be specified using &%condition%&.
.option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
.cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
-.cindex "&$domain_data$&"
+.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
the list. If the match is achieved by means of a file lookup, the data that the
lookup returned for the domain is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
-.cindex "&$address_data$&"
+.vindex "&$address_data$&"
If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
&*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
+.cindex "duplicate addresses"
+.oindex "&%unseen%&"
&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
+For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
+address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
+modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
+circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
+which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
+avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
&*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
-routers.
+routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
+warning for &%headers_add%& above.
.option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
domain that is being routed.
-.cindex "&$host_address$&"
+.vindex "&$host_address$&"
During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
checked.
.option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
.cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
-.cindex "prefix" "for local part; used in router"
+.cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
-.cindex "&$local_part$&"
-.cindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
+.vindex "&$local_part$&"
+.vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
check_local_user
transport = local_delivery
.endd
+For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
+router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
+.code
+ condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
+ {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
+.endd
+
If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
.code
local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain
.endd
-.cindex "&$local_part_data$&"
+.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
If the match is achieved by a lookup, the data that the lookup returned
for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
expansions of the router's private options. You might use this option, for
If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
-.cindex "&%self%& option"
+.oindex "&%self%&"
However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
means of the setting
.code
.option pass_router routers string unset
.cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
-When a router returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
+Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
+&(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
+routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
+these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
-&"decline"&.
+&"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
.option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
.cindex "router" "home directory for"
.cindex "home directory" "for router"
-.cindex "&$home$&"
+.vindex "&$home$&"
This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
&%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
rewritten.
.vitem &%pass%&
-.cindex "&%more%& option"
-.cindex "&$self_hostname$&"
+.oindex "&%more%&"
+.vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
&%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
-.cindex "&$host_address$&"
+.vindex "&$host_address$&"
The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
&%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
-the tranport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
+the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
sometimes true and sometimes false).
.cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
-The &%unseen%& option can be used to cause copies of messages to be delivered
-to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery. In
-effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children &--
-one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on to
-be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
+Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
+qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
+delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
+In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
+&-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
+to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
&%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
&*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
-no added headers and none specified for removal. However, any data that was set
-by the &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers is passed on.
-Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
-qualifier in filter files.
+no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
+a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
+duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
+duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
+&<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
+so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
+&%redirect%& router may be of help.
+Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
+&%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
+subsequent routers.
.option user routers string&!! "see below"
.option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
.cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
-.cindex "&%-bv%& option"
+.oindex "&%-bv%&"
.cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address or
testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
-.chapter "The accept router"
+.chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
.cindex "&(accept)& router"
.cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
.cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
.cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
-.cindex "&%self%& option" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
+.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
-.section "Private options for dnslookup"
+.section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
.cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
.cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
.cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
-record in order to be recognised. (The name of this option could be improved.)
+record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
setting:
when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
-.section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents"
+.section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
-.chapter "The ipliteral router"
+.chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
.cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
.cindex "domain literal" "routing"
.cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
-.cindex "&%self%& option" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
+.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
&%self%& option determines what happens.
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
-.chapter "The iplookup router"
+.chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
.cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
.cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
protocols is to be used.
-.option query iplookup string&!! "&`$local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain`&"
+.option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
-repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct query
-in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
+default value is:
+.code
+$local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
+.endd
+The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
+query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
.option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
-.chapter "The manualroute router"
+.chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
.scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
.scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
.cindex "domain" "manually routing"
generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
-.cindex "&$host$&"
+.vindex "&$host$&"
In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
.cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
+.option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
+See &%host_find_failed%&.
.option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
-of
+of the following values:
.code
decline
defer
fail
freeze
+ignore
pass
.endd
-The default assumes that this state is a serious configuration error. The
-difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former forces the
-address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
+The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
+error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
+forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
&%pass_router%&),
-.cindex "&%more%& option"
+.oindex "&%more%&"
overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
router only if &%more%& is true.
-This option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"& state; if a host
-lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the generic
-&%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
+The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
+cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
+controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
+as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
+
+The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
+state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
+generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
.option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
deferred.
-.option route_list manualroute " "string list" " semicolon-separated""
+.option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
-.section "Routing rules in route_list"
+.section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
-.section "Routing rules in route_data"
+.section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
-.section "Format of the list of hosts"
+.section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
&$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
.next
-.cindex "&$value$&"
+.vindex "&$value$&"
If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
.code
be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
happens is controlled by the
-.cindex "&%self%& option" "in &(manualroute)& router"
+.oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
&%self%& option of the router.
A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
&%host_find_failed%& option.
-.cindex "&$host$&"
+.vindex "&$host$&"
When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
-.section "Manualroute examples"
+.section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
batch_pipe
.endd
-.cindex "&$domain$&"
-.cindex "&$host$&"
+.vindex "&$domain$&"
+.vindex "&$host$&"
The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
result of the lookup is the result of that call.
-.cindex "&$address_data$&"
+.vindex "&$address_data$&"
If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
variable. For example, this return line
.code
.next
It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
.next
-It can be forced to fail, with a custom error message.
+It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
.next
-It can be temporarily deferred.
+It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
.next
It can be discarded.
.endlist
-.section "Redirection data"
+.section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
-.section "Forward files and address verification"
+.section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
.cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
&_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
-.section "Interpreting redirection data"
+.section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
.cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
.cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
&"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
removed.
-.cindex "&$local_part$&"
+.vindex "&$local_part$&"
&*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
.section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
.cindex "routing" "loops in"
-.cindex "loop while routing" "avoidance of"
+.cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
.cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
.cindex "backslash in alias file"
.cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
-preceeded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
+preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
synonymously.
the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
.cindex "black hole"
.cindex "abandoning mail"
-.code
-:blackhole:
-.endd
-can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is done, and no error
-message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing &_/dev/null_&, but
-can be independently disabled.
+&':blackhole:'& can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
+done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifing
+&_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
-&*Warning*&: If &`:blackhole:`& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
+&*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
.cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
.cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
.cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
-.cindex "deferred delivery" "forcing"
+.cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
.cindex "customizing" "failure message"
An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
redirection items of the form
:defer:
:fail:
.endd
-respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies to the
-entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored (&':blackhole:'& is
-different). Any text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error
-text associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
+respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
+to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
+text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
+associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
.code
X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
.endd
In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
of a
-.cindex "VRFY error text" "display of"
+.cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
default.
-.cindex "EXPN error text" "display of"
+.cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
&%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
ignored.
-.cindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
+.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
-.code
-:unknown:
-.endd
-This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)& router to
-decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which results in
-an empty redirection list has the same effect.
+&':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
+router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
+results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
.endlist
-.section "Duplicate addresses"
+.section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
.cindex "duplicate addresses"
-.cindex "address duplicate" "discarding"
+.cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
.cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
-.section "Repeated redirection expansion"
+.section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
.cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
.cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
can be used to avoid this.
-.section "Errors in redirection lists"
+.section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
.cindex "address redirection" "errors"
If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
-.section "Private options for the redirect router"
+.section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
.cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
.option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
-.cindex "&$address_file$&"
+.vindex "&$address_file$&"
A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
.option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
-.cindex "&$address_pipe$&"
+.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
.option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
-.cindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
+.vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
local_part_prefix = real-
transport = local_delivery
.endd
+For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
+router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
+.code
+ condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
+ {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
+.endd
+
.option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
-.section "Concurrent deliveries"
+.section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
.cindex "concurrent deliveries"
.cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
-If two different messages for the same local recpient arrive more or less
+If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
set.
-.cindex "&%initgroups%& option"
+.oindex "&%initgroups%&"
When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
&%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
-.section "Current and home directories"
+.section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
.cindex "current directory for local transport"
.cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
.cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
-.section "Expansion variables derived from the address"
-.cindex "&$domain$&"
-.cindex "&$local_part$&"
-.cindex "&$original_domain$&"
+.section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
+.vindex "&$domain$&"
+.vindex "&$local_part$&"
+.vindex "&$original_domain$&"
Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
.option home_directory transports string&!! unset
.cindex "transport" "home directory for"
-.cindex "&$home$&"
+.vindex "&$home$&"
This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
.option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
.cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
-.cindex "size of message" "limit"
+.cindex "size" "of message, limit"
.cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
-expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of digits,
-optionally followed by K or M.
-If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, or if the
-result is not of the required form, delivery is deferred.
-If the value is greater than zero and the size of a message exceeds this
-limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that the resulting bounce
-message could be routed to the same transport, you should ensure that
-&%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's &%message_size_limit%&, as
-otherwise the bounce message will fail to get delivered.
+expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
+digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
+including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
+delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
+message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
+the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
+ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
+&%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
+delivered.
.option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
-.cindex "prefix" "for local part; including in envelope"
-.cindex "suffix" "for local part; including in envelope"
+.cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
+.cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
.cindex "local part" "prefix"
.cindex "local part" "suffix"
When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
&*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
&%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
-.cindex "&$return_path$&"
+.vindex "&$return_path$&"
The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
&%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
-provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgement policies based on message
+provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
headers that some sites insist on.
are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
-care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. A demonstration Perl script is provided in
-&_util/transport-filter.pl_&; this makes a few arbitrary modifications just to
-show the possibilities. Exim does not check the result, except to test for a
-final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over SMTP must end
-with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
+care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
+test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
+SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
.cindex "content scanning" "per user"
A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
-.cindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
+.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
&(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
-.cindex "&$host$&"
-.cindex "&$host_address$&"
+.vindex "&$host$&"
+.vindex "&$host_address$&"
The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
which the message is being sent. For example:
expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
arguments. Consider this example:
.code
-transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/some/file}\
+transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
{$value}{/bin/cat}}
.endd
The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
.code
-transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/some/file}\
+transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
{$value}{/bin/cat}}
.endd
.endlist
.option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
-.cindex "transport filter" "timeout"
+.cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it a applies a timeout
that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
.option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
.cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
-.cindex "transport user" "specifying"
+.cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
copy of the message is delivered each time.
.cindex "batched local delivery"
-.cindex "&%batch_max%&"
-.cindex "&%batch_id%&"
+.oindex "&%batch_max%&"
+.oindex "&%batch_id%&"
In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
local transport, for example:
to certain conditions:
.ilist
-.cindex "&$local_part$&"
+.vindex "&$local_part$&"
If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
batching is possible.
.next
-.cindex "&$domain$&"
+.vindex "&$domain$&"
If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
addresses with the same domain are batched.
.next
addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
-.cindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
+.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
-are specififed by a &(redirect)& router.
+are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
included.
.cindex "quota" "system"
-Exim recognises system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
+Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
-.cindex "&$address_file$&"
-.cindex "&$local_part$&"
+.vindex "&$address_file$&"
+.vindex "&$local_part$&"
However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
-.section "Private options for appendfile"
+.section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
.cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
&<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
-.option directory_file appendfile string&!! &`q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode`&
+.option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
.cindex "base62"
-.cindex "&$inode$&"
+.vindex "&$inode$&"
When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
&%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
-whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value generates a
-unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the inode of the file.
-The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this option.
+whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
+.code
+q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
+.endd
+This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
+inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
+option.
.option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
.option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
.cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
-.cindex "mailbox locking" "blocking and non-blocking"
+.cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
.cindex "locking files"
By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
.cindex "locking files"
.cindex "file" "locking"
.cindex "file" "MBX format"
-.cindex "MBX format" "specifying"
+.cindex "MBX format, specifying"
This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
{MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
.endd
-
+&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
+&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
.option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
.code
message_suffix =
.endd
+&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
+&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
.option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
-if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifing
+if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
value, and this option is ignored.
of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
-The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
-written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
-are needed. In cases where these options have non-empty defaults, the values
-end with a single linefeed, so they must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if
-&%use_crlf%& is set.
+&*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
+(which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
+in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
+carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
+have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
+changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
.option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
-.section "Using tags to record message sizes"
+.section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
-.cindex "&$message_size$&"
+.vindex "&$message_size$&"
Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
&%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
-.section "Using a maildirsize file"
+.section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
.cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
.cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
details.
-.section "Mailstore delivery"
+.section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
.cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
&$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
-.section "Non-special new file delivery"
+.section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
-.chapter "The autoreply transport"
+.chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
.scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
.scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
of the original message that is included in the generated message when
&%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
-.cindex "&$sender_address$&"
+.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
-.section "Private options for autoreply"
+.section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
.cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
.option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
.option timeout lmtp time 5m
-The transport is aborted if the created process
-or Unix domain socket
-does not respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout.
-
-
-Here is an example of a typical LMTP transport:
+The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
+respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
+is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
+LMTP transport:
.code
lmtp:
driver = lmtp
following ways:
.ilist
-.cindex "&$local_part$&"
+.vindex "&$local_part$&"
A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
.next
-.cindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
+.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
(described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
that are routed to the transport.
.next
-.cindex "&$address_pipe$&"
+.vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If only
for a discussion of local delivery batching.
-.section "Concurrent delivery"
+.section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
-.section "Returned status and data"
+.section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
.cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
.cindex "transport" "filter"
.cindex "filter" "transport filter"
-.cindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
+.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
&`$pipe_addresses`&. This is not a general expansion variable; the only
place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
-.section "Private options for pipe"
+.section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
.cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
.code
message_prefix =
.endd
+&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
+&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
+
.option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
.code
message_suffix =
.endd
+&*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
+&`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
+
-.option path pipe string &`/bin:/usr/bin`&
+.option path pipe string "see below"
This option specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
-variable of the subprocess. If the &%command%& option does not yield an
-absolute path name, the command is sought in the PATH directories, in the usual
-way. &*Warning*&: This does not apply to a command specified as a transport
-filter.
+variable of the subprocess. The default is:
+.code
+/bin:/usr/bin
+.endd
+If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
+sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
+apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
+
+
+.option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
+Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
+a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
+during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
+It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
+for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
+resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
+installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
+of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
.option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
-are needed. Since the default values for both &%message_prefix%& and
-&%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, their values must be changed to
-end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
+are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
+&%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
+values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
.option use_shell pipe boolean false
-.cindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
+.vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
&<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
-.section "Using an external local delivery agent"
+.section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
.cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
.cindex "&'procmail'&"
.cindex "external local delivery"
envelope_to_add
check_string = "From "
escape_string = ">From "
+ umask = 077
user = $local_part
group = mail
&<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
-.section "Multiple messages on a single connection"
+.section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
two ways:
-.section "Use of the $host variable"
-.cindex "&$host$&"
-.cindex "&$host_address$&"
+.section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
+.vindex "&$host$&"
+.vindex "&$host_address$&"
At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
&$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
&%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
+.section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
+.vindex &$tls_cipher$&
+.vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
+At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_cipher$&
+and &$tls_peerdn$& are the values that were set when the message was received.
+These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
+SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these two
+variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
+appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
+are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
+&%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
-.section "Private options for smtp"
+
+.section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
.cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
-.new
.option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
-.wen
.option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
.cindex "local host" "sending to"
to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
ignored.
+The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
+started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
+&$tls_cipher$&, and &$tls_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
+particular connection.
+
If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
&%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
.option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
-.cindex "&%search_parents%&"
If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
&%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
zero.
-
.option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
-.option helo_data smtp string&!! &`$primary_hostname`&
-.cindex "HELO argument" "setting"
-.cindex "EHLO argument" "setting"
-.cindex "LHLO argument" "setting"
-The value of this option is expanded, and used as the argument for the EHLO,
-HELO, or LHLO command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The
-variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the identity of the remote
-host, and can be used to generate different values for different servers.
+.option gnutls_require_kx smtp string unset
+This option controls the key exchange mechanisms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
+client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
+
+.option gnutls_require_mac smtp string unset
+This option controls the MAC algorithms when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
+client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
+
+.option gnutls_require_protocols smtp string unset
+This option controls the protocols when GnuTLS is used in an Exim
+client. For details, see section &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
+
+.option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
+This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
+server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
+implementations of TLS.
+
+.option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
+.cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
+.cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
+.cindex "LHLO argument setting"
+The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
+been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
+command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
+option is:
+.code
+$primary_hostname
+.endd
+During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
+the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
+&$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
+used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
+servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
+that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
+interface address, you could use this:
+.code
+helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address}{$value}\
+ {$primary_hostname}}
+.endd
+The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
+callouts.
.option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
.option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
-.cindex "ESMTP" "avoiding use of"
+.cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
.cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
.cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
+.option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
+.cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
+Exim will not use the SMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
+that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
+
+
.option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
.cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
&%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
-router), and were not randomizied by the router, the order of trying the hosts
+router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
list can be used to do crude load sharing.
&<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
.option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
-.new
.cindex "bind IP address"
.cindex "IP address" "binding"
-.cindex "&$host$&"
-.cindex "&$host_address$&"
+.vindex "&$host$&"
+.vindex "&$host_address$&"
This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
-call. &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used
-when a message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly
-known as &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with
-the outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
+call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
+&`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
+message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
+&$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
+outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
unknown.
-.wen
During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
&$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
-of the connection should send a acknowledgement if the connection is still okay
+of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
.option multi_domain smtp boolean true
-.cindex "&$domain$&"
+.vindex "&$domain$&"
When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
.option port smtp string&!! "see below"
-.new
.cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
.cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
variable that contains an outgoing port.
-.wen
If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
.option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
-.cindex "TLS client certificate" "location of"
-.cindex "certificate for client" "location of"
-.cindex "&$host$&"
-.cindex "&$host_address$&"
+.cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
+.cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
+.vindex "&$host$&"
+.vindex "&$host_address$&"
The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
.option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
-.cindex "TLS client private key" "location of"
-.cindex "&$host$&"
-.cindex "&$host_address$&"
+.cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
+.vindex "&$host$&"
+.vindex "&$host_address$&"
The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
.option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
.cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
-.cindex "&$host$&"
-.cindex "&$host_address$&"
+.vindex "&$host$&"
+.vindex "&$host_address$&"
The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
.option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! unset
.cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
.cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
-.cindex "&$host$&"
-.cindex "&$host_address$&"
+.vindex "&$host$&"
+.vindex "&$host_address$&"
The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file containing
permitted server certificates, for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
Alternatively, if you are using OpenSSL, you can set
do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
-.section "Explicitly configured address rewriting"
+.section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
&%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
-.section "When does rewriting happen?"
+.section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
.cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
.cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
message's processing.
-.cindex "&$sender_address$&"
+.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SECTrewriteS>>&), but no
ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
-.cindex "&$domain$&"
-.cindex "&$local_part$&"
+.vindex "&$domain$&"
+.vindex "&$local_part$&"
Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
-.section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input"
+.section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
.cindex "rewriting" "testing"
.cindex "testing" "rewriting"
Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the run time
set for a particular transport.
-.section "Rewriting rules"
+.section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
.cindex "rewriting" "rules"
The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
rules in the form
(or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
-.cindex "&$domain$&"
-.cindex "&$local_part$&"
+.vindex "&$domain$&"
+.vindex "&$local_part$&"
The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
refer to the address that is being rewritten.
-.section "Rewriting patterns"
+.section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
.cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
.cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
.endlist
-.section "Rewriting replacements"
+.section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
.cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
&'From:'& headers.
-.cindex "&$domain$&"
-.cindex "&$local_part$&"
+.vindex "&$domain$&"
+.vindex "&$local_part$&"
If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
&$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
-.section "Rewriting flags"
+.section "Rewriting flags" "SECID153"
There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
.ilist
-.section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite"
+.section "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
+ "SECID154"
.cindex "rewriting" "flags"
If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
&<<SECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
&`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
&`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
.endd
+"All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
+individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
+other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
+
You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
-.cindex "&$domain$&"
-.cindex "&$local_part$&"
+.vindex "&$domain$&"
+.vindex "&$local_part$&"
This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
-.section "Flags controlling the rewriting process"
+.section "Flags controlling the rewriting process" "SECID155"
There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
.endlist
-.section "Rewriting examples"
+.section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
.code
*@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
.chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
-.scindex IIDretconf1 "retry configuration" "description of"
+.scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
.scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
-The &"retry"& section of the run time configuration file contains a list of
+The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
-be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules, temporary
-errors are treated as permanent. The &%-brt%& command line option can be used
-to test which retry rule will be used for a given address, domain and error.
+be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
+empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
+errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
+general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
+line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
+address, domain and error.
The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
the local address is reached.
-.section "Changing retry rules"
+.section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
-.section "Format of retry rules"
+.section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
.cindex "retry" "rules"
Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
.endd
-.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors"
+.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
&%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
local transports).
-.new
.cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
&%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
commands.
-.wen
-.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors"
+.section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
+ "SECID160"
For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
textual form of the IP address.
-.section "Retry rules for specific errors"
+.section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
.cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
-.section "Retry rules for specified senders"
+.section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
.cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
-.section "Retry parameters"
+.section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
.cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
.next
&'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
-maximum for the next interval. The mininum interval is the first argument of
+maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
interval is found. The main configuration variable
.cindex "limit" "retry interval"
-.cindex "retry interval" "maximum"
-.cindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
+.cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
+.oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
&%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
deliveries that have been deferred.
-.section "Retry rule examples"
+.section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
Here are some example retry rules:
.code
alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
-.section "Timeout of retry data"
+.section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
.cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
-.cindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
+.oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
.cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
.cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
-.section "Long-term failures"
-.cindex "delivery failure" "long-term"
+.section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
+.cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
.cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
post-cutoff retry time is not used.
If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
-.cindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
+.oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
&%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses is
reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
true.
-.section "Deliveries that work intermittently"
+.section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
.cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
&`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
&`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
&`Connected to server.example.`&
-&`Escape character is '^]'.`&
+&`Escape character is '^]'.`&
&`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
&*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
&`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
-.section "Generic options for authenticators"
+.section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
.cindex "authentication" "generic options"
.cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
+.option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
+When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
+&%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
+used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
+encrypted by a setting such as:
+.code
+client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_cipher}{}}
+.endd
+(Older documentation incorrectly states that &$tls_cipher$& contains the cipher
+used for incoming messages. In fact, during SMTP delivery, it contains the
+cipher used for the delivery.)
+
.option driver authenticators string unset
This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
-.new
.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
the error text.
-.wen
.option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
.option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
-.cindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
+.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
.next
If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
.next
-.cindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
+.vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
&$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
-.cindex "&$sender_address$&"
+.vindex "&$sender_address$&"
Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
-advertisement of a patricular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
+advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
such as:
.code
server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
.endd
-.cindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
+.vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
If the session is encrypted, &$tls_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
rejected with a 504 error.
-.cindex "&$received_protocol$&"
-.cindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
+.vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
+.vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
&$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
-.section "Testing server authentication"
+.section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
.cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
.cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
.cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
-.section "Authentication by an Exim client"
+.section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
.cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
&%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
.ilist
-For each authenticator that is configured as a client, it searches the
-authentication mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name
-matches the public name of the authenticator.
-.next
-.cindex "&$host$&"
-.cindex "&$host_address$&"
-When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code.
-The variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string
-expansions that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and
-IP address. If any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt
-is abandoned,
-and Exim moves on to the next authenticator.
-Otherwise an expansion failure causes delivery to be
-deferred.
+For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
+they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
+mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
+of the authenticator.
+.next
+.vindex "&$host$&"
+.vindex "&$host_address$&"
+When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
+variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
+that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
+any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
+Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
+delivery to be deferred.
.next
If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
connections as you do for login accounts.
-.new
-.section "Plaintext options"
+.section "Plaintext options" "SECID171"
.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
.option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
-.wen
.option server_prompts plaintext string&!! unset
The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
.cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
"in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
-.cindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
+.vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
.cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
-.cindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
+.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
&%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
-.section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism"
+.section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
.cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
.cindex "authentication" "PLAIN mechanism"
.cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
writing the test makes the logic clearer.
-.section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism"
+.section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
.cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
.cindex "authentication" "LOGIN mechanism"
The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
driver = plaintext
public_name = LOGIN
server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
- server_condition = ${if ldapauth \
- {user="cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
- pass=${quote:$auth2} \
- ldap://ldap.example.org/}}
+ server_condition = ${if and{{
+ !eq{}{$auth1} }{ \
+ ldapauth{user="cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
+ pass=${quote:$auth2} \
+ ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
.endd
-Note the use of the &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator to correctly quote the DN for
-authentication. However, the basic &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the
-LDAP quoting operators, is the correct one to use for the password, because
-quoting is needed only to make the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the
-LDAP level, the password is an uninterpreted string.
+We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
+does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
+operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
+&%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
+correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
+the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
+uninterpreted string.
-
-.section "Support for different kinds of authentication"
+.section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
-.section "Using plaintext in a client"
+.section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
.cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
-.chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator"
+.chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
.scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
.scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
.cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
available in plain text at either end.
-.section "Using cram_md5 as a server"
+.section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
authenticator as a server:
server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
server_set_id = $auth1
.endd
-.cindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
+.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
-name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more tyical configuration might look up the
+name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
.code
lookup_cram:
driver = cram_md5
public_name = CRAM-MD5
- server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}{$value}fail}
+ server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
+ {$value}fail}
server_set_id = $auth1
.endd
Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
-because &$1$& contains an unknown user name.
+because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
-.section "Using cram_md5 as a client"
+.section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
.cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
-.cindex "&$host$&"
-.cindex "&$host_address$&"
+.vindex "&$host$&"
+.vindex "&$host_address$&"
Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
-.chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator"
+.chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
.scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
.scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
.cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
depending on the driver you are using.
-.new
The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
-.wen
-.section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server"
+.section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
(on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
things.
-.option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! &`$primary_hostname`&
-This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with
-the library. It is up to the underlying SASL plug-in what it does with
-this data.
+.option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
+This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
+library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
+SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
-.option server_mech cyrus_sasl string &`public_name`&
-This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should
-use. It allows you to use a different underlying mechanism from the
-advertised name. For example:
+.option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
+This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
+default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
+you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
+example:
.code
sasl:
driver = cyrus_sasl
sasl_plain:
driver = cyrus_sasl
public_name = PLAIN
- server_set_id = $auth1
+ server_set_id = $auth2
.endd
Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
-.new
.chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
.scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
.scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
driver = dovecot
public_name = PLAIN
server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
- server_setid = $auth1
+ server_set_id = $auth2
dovecot_ntlm:
driver = dovecot
public_name = NTLM
server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
- server_setid = $auth1
+ server_set_id = $auth1
.endd
If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
&$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
-option is passed.
+option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
+who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
.ecindex IIDdcotauth1
.ecindex IIDdcotauth2
-.wen
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
-.section "Using spa as a server"
+.section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
-.section "Using spa as a client"
+.section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
.cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
-.section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol"
+.section "Support for the legacy &""ssmtp""& (aka &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
+ "SECID284"
.cindex "ssmtp protocol"
.cindex "smtps protocol"
.cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
port. The protocol was called &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, and port 465 was
allocated for this purpose.
-This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardised, but there are
+This approach was abandoned when encrypted SMTP was standardized, but there are
still some legacy clients that use it. Exim supports these clients by means of
the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& global option. Its value must be a list of port
numbers; the most common use is expected to be:
facility for varying its Diffie-Hellman parameters. I understand that this has
changed, but Exim has not been updated to provide this facility.
.next
-.cindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
+.vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
affects the value of the &$tls_peerdn$& variable.
OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS uses underscores, for example: RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is
more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present in a cipher list. To make
-life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyhens for OpenSSL and hyphens to
+life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens for OpenSSL and hyphens to
underscores for GnuTLS when processing lists of cipher suites in the
&%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
option).
.endlist
-.section "GnuTLS parameter computation"
-GnuTLS uses RSA and D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
+.section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECID181"
+GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
&_gnutls-params_&. The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
-its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the RSA and D-H
+its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
.section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
-.cindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
+.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
are acceptable. The list is colon separated and may contain names like
-
-.section "Requiring specific ciphers in GnuTLS" "SECTreqciphgnu"
-.cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (GnuTLS)"
-.cindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
-The GnuTLS library does not have a combined function like OpenSSL. Instead,
-it allows the caller to specify separate lists of key-exchange methods,
-main cipher algorithms, and MAC algorithms. Unfortunately, these lists are
-numerical, and the library does not have a function for turning names into
-numbers. Consequently, the list of recognized names has to be built into
-the application.
-
-At present, Exim permits only the list of main cipher algorithms to be
-changed. The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is in the same format as for
-OpenSSL. Exim searches each item for the name of available algorithm. For
-example, if the list contains RSA_AES_SHA then AES is recognized.
-
-The cipher algorithms list starts out with a default set of algorithms. If
-the first item in &%tls_require_ciphers%& does &'not'& start with an
-exclamation mark, all the default items are deleted. Thus, only those specified
-can be used. If the first item in &%tls_require_ciphers%& &'does'& start with
-an exclamation mark, the defaults are left on the list.
+.section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
+ "SECTreqciphgnu"
+.cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
+.cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
+.cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
+.cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
+.cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
+.oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
+The GnuTLS library allows the caller to specify separate lists of permitted key
+exchange methods, main cipher algorithms, MAC algorithms, and protocols.
+Unfortunately, these lists are numerical, and the library does not have a
+function for turning names into numbers. Consequently, lists of recognized
+names have to be built into the application. The permitted key exchange
+methods, ciphers, and MAC algorithms may be used in any combination to form a
+cipher suite. This is unlike OpenSSL, where complete cipher suite names are
+passed to its control function.
+
+For compatibility with OpenSSL, the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option can be set
+to complete cipher suite names such as RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA, but for GnuTLS this
+option controls only the cipher algorithms. Exim searches each item in the
+list for the name of an available algorithm. For example, if the list
+contains RSA_AES_SHA, then AES is recognized, and the behaviour is exactly
+the same as if just AES were given.
+
+.oindex "&%gnutls_require_kx%&"
+.oindex "&%gnutls_require_mac%&"
+.oindex "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&"
+There are additional options called &%gnutls_require_kx%&,
+&%gnutls_require_mac%&, and &%gnutls_require_protocols%& that can be used to
+restrict the key exchange methods, MAC algorithms, and protocols, respectively.
+These options are ignored if OpenSSL is in use.
+
+All four options are available as global options, controlling how Exim
+behaves as a server, and also as options of the &(smtp)& transport, controlling
+how Exim behaves as a client. All the values are string expanded. After
+expansion, the values must be colon-separated lists, though the separator
+can be changed in the usual way.
+
+Each of the four lists starts out with a default set of algorithms. If the
+first item in a list does &'not'& start with an exclamation mark, all the
+default items are deleted. In this case, only those that are explicitly
+specified can be used. If the first item in a list &'does'& start with an
+exclamation mark, the defaults are left on the list.
Then, any item that starts with an exclamation mark causes the relevant
-algorithms to be removed from the list, and any item that does not start
-with an exclamation mark causes the relevant algorithms to be added to the
-list. Thus,
+entry to be removed from the list, and any item that does not start with an
+exclamation mark causes a new entry to be added to the list. Unrecognized
+items in the list are ignored. Thus:
.code
-tls_require_ciphers = !RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA
+tls_require_ciphers = !ARCFOUR
.endd
-allows all the defaults except those that use ARCFOUR, whereas
+allows all the defaults except ARCFOUR, whereas
.code
tls_require_ciphers = AES : 3DES
.endd
-allows only cipher suites that use AES and 3DES. The currently recognized
-algorithms are: AES_256, AES_128, AES (both of the preceding), 3DES, and
-ARCFOUR_128. Unrecognized algorithms are ignored. In a server, the order of the
-list is unimportant; the server will advertise the availability of all the
-relevant cipher suites. However, in a client, the order of the list specifies a
-preference order for the algorithms. The first one in the client's list that is
+allows only cipher suites that use AES or 3DES.
+
+For &%tls_require_ciphers%& the recognized names are AES_256, AES_128, AES
+(both of the preceding), 3DES, ARCFOUR_128, ARCFOUR_40, and ARCFOUR (both of
+the preceding). The default list does not contain all of these; it just has
+AES_256, AES_128, 3DES, and ARCFOUR_128.
+
+For &%gnutls_require_kx%&, the recognized names are DHE_RSA, RSA (which
+includes DHE_RSA), DHE_DSS, and DHE (which includes both DHE_RSA and
+DHE_DSS). The default list contains RSA, DHE_DSS, DHE_RSA.
+
+For &%gnutls_require_mac%&, the recognized names are SHA (synonym SHA1), and
+MD5. The default list contains SHA, MD5.
+
+For &%gnutls_require_protocols%&, the recognized names are TLS1 and SSL3.
+The default list contains TLS1, SSL3.
+
+In a server, the order of items in these lists is unimportant. The server
+advertises the availability of all the relevant cipher suites. However, in a
+client, the order in the &%tls_require_ciphers%& list specifies a preference
+order for the cipher algorithms. The first one in the client's list that is
also advertised by the server is tried first. The default order is as listed
above.
-
-.section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS"
+.section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
.cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
but not to any others. The default value of this option is unset, which means
that STARTTLS is not advertised at all. This default is chosen because you
-need to set some other options in order to make TLS avaliable, and also it is
+need to set some other options in order to make TLS available, and also it is
sensible for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
.cindex "cipher" "logging"
.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
-.cindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
+.vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
The variable &$tls_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
&"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
-
-The ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can check the name of the cipher
-suite and vary their actions accordingly. The cipher suite names are those used
-by OpenSSL. These may differ from the names used elsewhere. For example,
-OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other contexts
-is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL
+(For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_cipher$& is reset &-- see section
+&<<SECID185>>&.)
+
+Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
+can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
+cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
+example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
+contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
documentation for more details.
-
-.section "Requesting and verifying client certificates"
+.section "Requesting and verifying client certificates" "SECID183"
.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
-.cindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
+.vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
&$tls_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
certificate is supplied, &$tls_peerdn$& is empty.
-.section "Revoked certificates"
+.section "Revoked certificates" "SECID184"
.cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
.cindex "revocation list"
.cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
CRL in PEM format.
-.section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS"
+.section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECID185"
.cindex "cipher" "logging"
.cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
.cindex "log" "distinguished name"
unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
unencrypted.
-
The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
if it requests it. If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
-&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client. &*Note*&:
-These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
-is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
-by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
-client.
+&%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
-If &%tls_verify_certificates%& is set, it must name a file or,
+If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
+must name a file or,
for OpenSSL only (not GnuTLS), a directory, that contains a collection of
expected server certificates. The client verifies the server's certificate
against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
alternative hosts, if any.
-.cindex "&$host$&"
-.cindex "&$host_address$&"
+ &*Note*&:
+These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
+is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
+by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
+client.
+
+.vindex "&$host$&"
+.vindex "&$host_address$&"
All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
&$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
behave as if the relevant option were unset.
+.vindex &$tls_cipher$&
+.vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
+Before an SMTP connection is established, the &$tls_cipher$& and &$tls_peerdn$&
+variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
+that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
+successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
+outgoing connection.
+
.section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
.endd
-.section "Certificate chains"
+.section "Certificate chains" "SECID186"
The file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
-.section "Self-signed certificates"
+.section "Self-signed certificates" "SECID187"
.cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
with OpenSSL, like this:
one very small ACL:
.code
begin acl
-
small_acl:
accept hosts = one.host.only
.endd
&<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
-.section "Testing ACLs"
+.section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
The host &'relay-test.mail-abuse.org'& provides a service for checking your
-.section "Specifying when ACLs are used"
+.section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
.cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
.cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
-.cindex "QUIT" "ACL for"
+.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
.cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
-.cindex "STARTTLS" "ACL for"
+.cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
.cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
-.cindex "SMTP connection" "ACL for"
-.cindex "non-smtp message" "ACLs for"
-.cindex "MIME parts" "ACL for"
+.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
+.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
+.cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
.table2 140pt
-.row &~&%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
-.row &~&%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
-.row &~&%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
-.row &~&%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
-.row &~&%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
-.row &~&%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
-.row &~&%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
-.row &~&%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
-.row &~&%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
-.row &~&%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
-.row &~&%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
-.row &~&%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
-.row &~&%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
-.row &~&%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
-.row &~&%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
-.row &~&%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
-.row &~&%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
+.irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
+.irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
+.irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
+.irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
+.irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
+.irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
+.irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
+.irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
+.irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
+.irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
+.irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
+.irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
+.irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
+.irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
+.irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
+.irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
+.irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
+.irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
.endtable
For example, if you set
testing as possible at RCPT time.
-.section "The non-SMTP ACLs"
-.cindex "non-smtp message" "ACLs for"
+.section "The non-SMTP ACLs" "SECID190"
+.cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
-analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) The result of this
-ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you really need to,
-you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based on that in the
-&%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set controls, and in
-particular, it can be used to set
+analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
+batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
+result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
+really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
+on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
+controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
.code
control = suppress_local_fixups
.endd
temporary error for these kinds of message.
-.section "The SMTP connect ACL"
-.new
-.cindex "SMTP connection" "ACL for"
-.cindex &%smtp_banner%&
+.section "The SMTP connect ACL" "SECID191"
+.cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
+.oindex &%smtp_banner%&
The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
&%smtp_banner%& option.
-.section "The EHLO/HELO ACL"
+.section "The EHLO/HELO ACL" "SECID192"
.cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
.cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
an EHLO response.
-.wen
-.section "The DATA ACLs"
+.section "The DATA ACLs" "SECID193"
.cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
command, with two responses being sent to the client.
your resources.
-.section "The SMTP MIME ACL"
+.section "The SMTP MIME ACL" "SECID194"
The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
.section "The QUIT ACL" "SECTQUITACL"
-.cindex "QUIT" "ACL for"
+.cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
does not in fact control any access. For this reason, the only verbs that are
connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
+.section "The not-QUIT ACL" "SECTNOTQUITACL"
+.vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
+The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
+an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is is bad
+trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
+because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
+situation even worse.
+
+Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
+logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
+modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
+and &%warn%&.
-.section "Finding an ACL to use"
+.vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
+When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
+to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
+connection. The possible values are:
+.table2
+.irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
+.irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
+.irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
+.irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
+.irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
+.irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
+.irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
+.irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
+.irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
+.irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
+.endtable
+In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
+Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
+With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
+overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
+&%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
+used.
+
+
+.section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
.cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
-.section "ACL return codes"
+.section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
.cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
-.section "Unset ACL options"
+.section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
.cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
-.section "Data for message ACLs"
+.section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
.cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
-.cindex &$domain$&
-.cindex &$local_part$&
-.cindex &$sender_address$&
-.cindex &$sender_host_address$&
-.cindex &$smtp_command$&
+.vindex &$domain$&
+.vindex &$local_part$&
+.vindex &$sender_address$&
+.vindex &$sender_host_address$&
+.vindex &$smtp_command$&
When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
&$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
how it is used.
-.cindex "&$message_size$&"
+.vindex "&$message_size$&"
The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
received).
-.cindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
-.cindex "&$recipients_count$&"
+.vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
+.vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
.section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
.cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
-.cindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
-.cindex &$smtp_command$&
+.vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
+.vindex &$smtp_command$&
When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
-.section "Format of an ACL"
+.section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
.cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
-.cindex "&ACL;" "verbs; definition of"
+.cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
An individual ACL consists of a number of statements. Each statement starts
with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
-.section "ACL verbs"
+.section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
The ACL verbs are as follows:
.ilist
-.cindex "&%accept%&" "ACL verb"
+.cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
&%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
&%endpass%&.
-.new
The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
configuration.
-.cindex "&%message%&" "ACL modifier, with &%accept%&"
+.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
(when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
.display
&`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
-&` message = OK, I'll allow you through today`&
+&` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
.endd
You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
of &%endpass%&.
-.wen
.next
-.cindex "&%defer%&" "ACL verb"
+.cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
&%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
&%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
.next
-.cindex "&%deny%&" "ACL verb"
+.cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
&%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
example,
.next
-.new
-.cindex "&%discard%&" "ACL verb"
+.cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
&%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
&"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
-do not appear in the log line when the &%log_recipients%& log selector is set.
+do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
-.wen
.next
-.cindex "&%drop%&" "ACL verb"
+.cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
&%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
.code
The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
.next
-.cindex "&%require%&" "ACL verb"
+.cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
&%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
example, when checking a RCPT command,
.code
-require verify = sender
+require message = Sender did not verify
+ verify = sender
.endd
passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
-verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command.
+verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
+&%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
+discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
.next
-.cindex "&%warn%&" "ACL verb"
+.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
&%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
&%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
-&new("This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
-is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer,") no further
+This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
+is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
onwards.
-.cindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
+.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
.section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
-.new
.cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
on the same SMTP connection.
.next
-The values of those variables whose names beging with &$acl_m$& persist only
+The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
.endlist
Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
-.wen
-.section "Condition and modifier processing"
+.section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
.cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
.cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
+.vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
+.cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
+.cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
+This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
+continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
+the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
+update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
+write rather ugly lines like this:
+.display
+&`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
+.endd
+Instead, all you need is
+.display
+&`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
+.endd
+
.vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
-.cindex "&%control%&" "ACL modifier"
+.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
in several different ways. For example:
. ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
-. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
+. ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
+. ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
+. ==== way.
.ilist
It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
&%require%& verb. For example:
.code
- require control = no_multiline_response
+ require control = no_multiline_responses
.endd
.endlist
.vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
-.cindex "&%delay%&" "ACL modifier"
-.cindex "&%-bh%& option"
-This modifier causes Exim to wait for the time interval before proceeding. The
-time is given in the usual Exim notation. This modifier may appear in any ACL.
-The delay happens as soon as the modifier is processed. However, when testing
-Exim using the &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an
-appropriate message is output instead).
+.cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
+.oindex "&%-bh%&"
+This modifier may appear in any ACL. It causes Exim to wait for the time
+interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the &%-bh%&
+option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is output
+instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay happens
+as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending output is
+flushed before the delay is imposed.
Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
example:
accept ...
.endd
-.new
+If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
+responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
+they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
+delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
+appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
+unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
+using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
+
+
.vitem &*endpass*&
-.cindex "&%endpass%&" "ACL modifier"
+.cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
&%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
&"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
-.wen
.vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
-.cindex "&%log_message%&" "ACL modifier"
+.cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
.code
require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_cipher
encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
.endd
-.new
&%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
example:
.display
variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
&%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
ignored.
-.wen
-.cindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
+.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
error message.
more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
-is logged for a succesful &%warn%& statement.
+is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
logging rejections.
-.new
.vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
-.cindex "&%log_reject_target%&" "ACL modifier"
+.cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
.cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
&` log_reject_target =`&
.endd
This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
-permanent and temporary rejections.
-.wen
+permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
+current ACL.
.vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
-.cindex "&%logwrite%&" "ACL modifier"
+.cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
.cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
-&%warn%& &new("and &%discard%&"), is used only if the ACL statement denies
+&%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
ACLs. For example:
.display
.vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
-.new
-.cindex "&%message%&" "ACL modifier"
+.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
processed.)
.cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
-.cindex "&%smtp_banner%&
+.oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
anyway. If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
response.
-.wen
-.cindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
+.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
However, the original message is available in the variable
.vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
-.cindex "&%set%&" "ACL modifier"
+.cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
&<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
.endlist
.section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
-.cindex "&%control%&" "ACL modifier"
+.cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
.vlist
by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
-.vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*&
-See below.
-
-.vitem &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
+.vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
+ &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
.cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
.cindex "case of local parts"
-.cindex "&$local_part$&"
+.vindex "&$local_part$&"
These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
(that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
-.vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*&
-See below.
-
-.vitem &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
+.vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
+.cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
+.cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
+This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
+with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile, by default called
+&'debuglog'&. The filename can be adjusted with the &'tag'& option, which
+may access any variables already defined. The logging may be adjusted with
+the &'opts'& option, which takes the same values as the &`-d`& command-line
+option. Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
+contexts):
+.code
+ control = debug
+ control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
+ control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
+ control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
+.endd
+
+.vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
+ &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
.cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
.cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
.vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
.cindex "fake defer"
-.cindex "defer" "fake"
+.cindex "defer, fake"
This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
.vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
.cindex "fake rejection"
-.cindex "rejection" "fake"
+.cindex "rejection, fake"
This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
.endd
-This facilty should be used with extreme caution.
+This facility should be used with extreme caution.
.vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
.cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
+.vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
+.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
+Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
+avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
+use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
+disables such output flushing.
+
+.vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
+.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
+Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
+avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
+use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
+that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
.vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
to be useful in production.
-.vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_response*&
-.cindex "multiline responses" "suppressing"
+.vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
+.cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
+.vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
+.cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
+This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
+the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
+response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
+controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
+&%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
+
.vitem &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
-.cindex "&%queue_only%&"
+.oindex "&%queue_only%&"
.cindex "queueing incoming messages"
This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
-necessary. For example, it add a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
+necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
late (the message has already been created).
that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
.vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
-.cindex "submission fixups" "suppressing"
+.cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
-complement of &`control`& &`=`& &`submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
+complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
.ilist
used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
data is read.
+
+&*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
+that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
.endlist vlist
+
+.section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
.ilist
Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
.next
-Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use &`control`& &`=`&
-&`suppress_local_fixups`&.
+Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
+&`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
.next
Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
.next
-Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control`& &`=`& &`submission`&.
+Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
.endlist
.section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
.cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
.cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
-.cindex "&%message%&" "ACL modifier"
+.cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
to an incoming message, as in this example:
.code
ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
honoured.
-.cindex "&%warn%&" "ACL verb"
+.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
&%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
.vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
.cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
.cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
-.cindex "&%acl%&" "ACL condition"
+.cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
&%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
&"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
for different local users or different local domains.
.vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
-.cindex "&%authenticated%&" "ACL condition"
+.cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
.cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
.endd
.vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
-.cindex "&%condition%&" "ACL condition"
+.cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
.cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
.cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
-.cindex "&ACL;" "testing; customized"
+.cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
&"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
negative.
.vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
-.cindex "&%decode%&" "ACL condition"
+.cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
&%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
-For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
+If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
+problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
+chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
.vitem &*demime&~=&~*&<&'extension&~list'&>
-.cindex "&%demime%&" "ACL condition"
+.cindex "&%demime%& ACL condition"
This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
content-scanning extension. Its use is described in section
&<<SECTdemimecond>>&.
.vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
-.cindex "&%dnslists%&" "ACL condition"
+.cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
.cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
.cindex "black list (DNS)"
.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
&"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
-&<<SECTmorednslists>>&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
+&<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
.vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
-.cindex "&%domains%&" "ACL condition"
+.cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
.cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
-.cindex "&$domain_data$&"
+.vindex "&$domain_data$&"
This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the domain
of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
&%domains%& test.
-.new
&*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
-.wen
.vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
-.cindex "&%encrypted%&" "ACL condition"
+.cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
.cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
.cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
.vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'&~host&~list'&>
-.cindex "&%hosts%&" "ACL condition"
+.cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
.cindex "host" "ACL checking"
.cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
.code
accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
.endd
-.new
The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
-.wen
The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
statement can then check the IP address.
-.cindex "&$host_data$&"
+.vindex "&$host_data$&"
If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
.vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
-.cindex "&%local_parts%&" "ACL condition"
+.cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
.cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
-.cindex "&$local_part_data$&"
+.vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks that the local
part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
the next &%local_parts%& test.
.vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
-.cindex "&%malware%&" "ACL condition"
+.cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
.cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
.vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
-.cindex "&%mime_regex%&" "ACL condition"
+.cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
.vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
-.cindex "&%recipients%&" "ACL condition"
+.cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
.cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It checks the entire
recipient address against a list of recipients.
.vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
-.cindex "&%regex%&" "ACL condition"
+.cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
.cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
.vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
-.cindex "&%sender_domains%&" "ACL condition"
+.cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
-.cindex "&$domain$&"
-.cindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
+.vindex "&$domain$&"
+.vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
&$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
.vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
-.cindex "&%senders%&" "ACL condition"
+.cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
.cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
.vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
-.cindex "&%spam%&" "ACL condition"
+.cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
.cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
.vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
-.cindex "&%verify%&" "ACL condition"
+.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
.cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
.cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
.cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
&<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
-.cindex "&%verify%&" "ACL condition"
+.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
.cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
.cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
.endd
.vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
-.cindex "&%verify%&" "ACL condition"
+.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
.cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
.cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
common as they used to be.
.vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
-.cindex "&%verify%&" "ACL condition"
+.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
.cindex "HELO" "verifying"
.cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
&%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
independently of this condition.
-.new
For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
option), this condition is always true.
-.wen
.vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind*&
.cindex "verifying" "not blind"
-.cindex "bcc recipients" "verifying none"
+.cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
&'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
.vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
-.cindex "&%verify%&" "ACL condition"
+.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
.cindex "recipient" "verifying"
.cindex "verifying" "recipient"
-.cindex "&$address_data$&"
+.vindex "&$address_data$&"
This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
&<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
value for the child address.
.vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup*&
-.cindex "&%verify%&" "ACL condition"
+.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
.cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
-.cindex "&%verify%&" "ACL condition"
+.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
.cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
.cindex "sender" "verifying"
.cindex "verifying" "sender"
the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
-.cindex "&$address_data$&"
-.cindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
+.vindex "&$address_data$&"
+.vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
to avoid doing it more than once per message.
.vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
-.cindex "&%verify%&" "ACL condition"
+.cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
verified as a sender.
.endlist
.cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
-address in one or more DNS domains. For example, if the calling host's IP
+address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
+domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
+special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
.code
deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
-.section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup"
+.section "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" "SECID201"
.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
-.section "DNS lists keyed on domain names"
+.section "DNS lists keyed on domain names" "SECID202"
.cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
addresses (see for example the &'domain based zones'& link at
Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
+The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
+&$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
-.section "Data returned by DNS lists"
+.section "Data returned by DNS lists" "SECID203"
.cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
127.1.0.6 RSS and DUL
127.1.0.7 RSS and DUL and RBL
.endd
-.new
Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
-different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record; they
-are all checked.
-.wen
+different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
+see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
-.section "Variables set from DNS lists"
-.new
+
+.section "Variables set from DNS lists" "SECID204"
+.cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
.cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
-.cindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
-.cindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
-.cindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
-When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$&
-contains the name of the domain that matched, and &$dnslist_value$& contains
-the data from the entry. If more than one address record is returned by the DNS
-lookup, all the IP addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by
-commas and spaces. The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any
-associated TXT record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry
-is often not very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of
-obtaining more information.
-.wen
+.vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
+.vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
+.vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
+.vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
+When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
+the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
+&`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
+(for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
+the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
+&$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
+cases, for example:
+.code
+deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
+.endd
+the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
+&$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
+For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
+might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
+.code
+deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
+.endd
+If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
+&`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
+
+If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
+addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
+The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
+record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
+very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
+information.
You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
&-- although these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
.endd
rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
-any address record is considered to be a match. If more than one address record
-is found on the list, they are all checked for a matching right-hand side.
+any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
+that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
+describes how multiple records are handled.
More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
-.section "Negated DNS matching conditions"
+.section "Negated DNS matching conditions" "SECID205"
You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
condition. Whereas
.code
which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
-.new
+
+
+.section "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" "SECThanmuldnsrec"
+A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
+thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
+is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
+the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
+the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
+.code
+dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
+.endd
+What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
+127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
+condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
+because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
+affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
+additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
+
+.ilist
+If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
+IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
+condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
+.next
+If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
+looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
+changed to:
+.code
+dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
+.endd
+and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
+false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
+.code
+dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
+.endd
+for the condition to be true.
+.endlist
+
+When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
+the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
+.ilist
+If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
+addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
+.code
+dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
+.endd
+If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
+false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
+.next
+If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true there is at least one
+looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
+.code
+dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
+.endd
+If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
+true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
+.code
+dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
+.endd
+for the condition to be false.
+.endlist
+When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
+between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
+
+
+
+
.section "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" "SECTmordetinf"
.cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
.code
reject message = \
- rejected because $sender_ip_address is blacklisted \
+ rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
dnslists = \
sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
-.wen
dnslists = some.list.example
.endd
-.section "Rate limiting senders" "SECTratelimiting"
+.section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
.cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
.cindex "limiting client sending rates"
.oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
-changing its overall sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
+changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
instructions when it is run with no arguments.
The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
-sending rate. This data is stored in a database maintained by Exim in its spool
-directory, alongside the retry and other hints databases. The default key is
-&$sender_host_address$&, which applies the limit to each client host IP address.
+sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
+retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
+which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
&$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
-authenticated, and you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition.
+authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
+
+The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
+rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
+&`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
+ACL.
-Internally, Exim includes the smoothing constant &'p'& and the options in the
+Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& and the options onto the
lookup key because they alter the meaning of the stored data. This is not true
for the limit &'m'&, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will
still remember clients' past behaviour, but if you alter the other ratelimit
parameters Exim forgets past behaviour.
-Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to two options. The first option
+Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to three options. One option
specifies what Exim measures the rate of, and the second specifies how Exim
-handles excessively fast clients. The options are separated by a slash, like
-the other parameters.
+handles excessively fast clients. The third option can be &`noupdate`&, to
+disable updating of the ratelimiting database (see section &<<rearatdat>>&).
+The options are separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may
+appear in any order.
+.section "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" "ratoptmea"
The &%per_conn%& option limits the client's connection rate.
The &%per_mail%& option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
The &%per_byte%& option limits the sender's email bandwidth. Note that it is
best to use this option in the DATA ACL; if it is used in an earlier ACL it
-relies on the SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or
-completely missing. You can follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K,
-M, or G to specify limits in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
+relies on the SIZE parameter specified by the client in its MAIL command,
+which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can follow the limit &'m'&
+in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits in kilobytes,
+megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
+
+The &%per_rcpt%& option causes Exim to limit the rate at which
+recipients are accepted. To be effective, it would need to be used in
+either the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& or the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. In the
+&%acl_smtp_rcpt%& ACL, the number of recipients is incremented by one.
+In the case of a locally submitted message in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL,
+the number of recipients is incremented by the &%$recipients_count%&
+for the entire message. Note that in either case the rate limiting
+engine will see a message with many recipients as a large high-speed
+burst.
The &%per_cmd%& option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
-condition is processed. This can be used to limit the SMTP command rate. The
-alias &%per_rcpt%& is provided for use in the RCPT ACL instead of &%per_cmd%&
-to make it clear that the effect is to limit the rate at which recipients are
-accepted. Note that in this case the rate limiting engine will see a message
-with many recipients as a large high-speed burst.
+condition is processed. This can be used to limit the SMTP command rate.
+This command is essentially an alias of &%per_rcpt%& to make it clear
+that the effect is to limit the rate at which individual commands,
+rather than recipients, are accepted.
+.section "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" "ratophanfas"
If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
&%strict%& or &%leaky%& options. This is independent of the other
rest of the ACL. The default mode is leaky, which avoids a sender's
over-aggressive retry rate preventing it from getting any email through.
-The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always updated.
-The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate of attempts
-to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum. If the client is over
-the limit it will be subjected to counter-measures until it slows down below
-the maximum rate. The smoothing period determines the time it takes for a high
-sending rate to decay exponentially to 37% of its peak value, which means that
-you can work out the time (the number of smoothing periods) that a client is
-subjected to counter-measures after an over-limit burst with this formula:
-.code
-ln(peakrate/maxrate)
-.endd
-The &%leaky%& option means that the client's recorded rate is not updated if it
-is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's
-average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than the
-maximum. If the client is over the limit it &new("may suffer some
-counter-measures (as specified in the ACL)"), but it will still be able to send
+The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
+updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
+of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
+actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
+counter-measures by the ACL until it slows down below the maximum rate. If
+the client stops attempting to send email for the time specified in the &'p'&
+parameter then its computed rate will decay exponentially to 37% of its peak
+value. You can work out the time (the number of smoothing periods) that a
+client is subjected to counter-measures after an over-limit burst with this
+formula:
+.code
+ ln(peakrate/maxrate)
+.endd
+The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
+updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
+client's average rate of successfully sent email, which cannot be greater than
+the maximum allowed. If the client is over the limit it may suffer some
+counter-measures (as specified in the ACL), but it will still be able to send
email at the configured maximum rate, whatever the rate of its attempts. This
is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
+.section "Using rate limiting" "useratlim"
Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
(for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
+.section "Reading ratelimit data without updating" "rearatdat"
+.cindex "rate limitint" "reading data without updating"
+If the &%noupdate%& option is present on a &%ratelimit%& ACL condition, Exim
+computes the rate and checks the limit as normal, but it does not update the
+saved data. This means that, in relevant ACLs, it is possible to lookup the
+existence of a specified (or auto-generated) ratelimit key without incrementing
+the ratelimit counter for that key. In order for this to be useful, another ACL
+entry must set the rate for the same key (otherwise it will always be zero).
+For example:
+.code
+acl_check_connect:
+ deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict / per_cmd / noupdate
+ log_message = RATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
+ (max $sender_rate_limit)
+.endd
+.display
+&'... some other logic and tests...'&
+.endd
+.code
+acl_check_mail:
+ warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict / per_cmd
+ condition = ${if le{$sender_rate}{$sender_rate_limit}}
+ logwrite = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
+ (max $sender_rate_limit)
+.endd
+In this example, the rate is tested and used to deny access (when it is too
+high) in the connect ACL, but the actual computation of the remembered rate
+happens later, on a per-command basis, in another ACL.
+
+
+
.section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
.cindex "verifying address" "options for"
.cindex "policy control" "address verification"
.endlist
.cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
-.cindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
-.cindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
-.cindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
+.vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
+.vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
+.vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
coding like this:
&%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
supplies a host list.
-.new
The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
&`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
&`QUIT`&
.endd
-.wen
LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
set to &"lmtp"&.
hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
&%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
+.cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
+A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
+output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
+clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
+disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
.vlist
.vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
-.cindex "callout timeout" "specifying"
+.cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
For example:
.code
verify = sender/callout=5s
.endd
The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
-remote host. It is also used for the intial connection, unless overridden by
+remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
the &%connect%& parameter.
.vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
-.cindex "callout connection timeout" "specifying"
+.cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
for making the SMTP connection. For example:
.code
If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
.vitem &*defer_ok*&
-.cindex "callout defer" "action on"
+.cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
updated in this circumstance.
.vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
-.cindex "callout overall timeout" "specifying"
+.cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
For example:
.code
.vitem &*no_cache*&
-.cindex "callout cache" "suppressing"
-.cindex "caching callout" "suppressing"
+.cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
+.cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
.vitem &*postmaster*&
.cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
-When this parameter is set, a sucessful callout check is followed by a similar
+When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
.code
deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
.endd
-.cindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
+.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
.section "Callout caching" "SECTcallvercache"
.cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
-.cindex "callout" "caching"
+.cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
.cindex "caching" "callout"
Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
-.new
When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
address and a report is output for each of them.
-.wen
.section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
-.cindex "BATV" "verifying"
+.cindex "BATV, verifying"
Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
use this:
.code
# Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
-deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path.
+deny message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
senders = :
recipients = +batv_senders
timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
-There are two more issues you must consider when implementing prvs-signing.
-Firstly, you need to ensure that prvs-signed addresses are not blocked by your
-ACLs. A prvs-signed address contains a slash character, but the default Exim
-configuration contains this statement in the RCPT ACL:
-.code
-deny message = Restricted characters in address
- domains = +local_domains
- local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
-.endd
-This is a conservative rule that blocks local parts that contain slashes. You
-should remove the slash in the last line.
-
-Secondly, you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
+There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
+you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
.code
this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
&_doc/experimental.txt_&.
-All the content-scanning facilites work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
+All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
temporarily created in a file called:
.display
<&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
in memory and thus are much faster.
-.cindex "&%av_scanner%&"
+.oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in first part of the Exim configuration
file to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
.code
av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
.endd
-If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with dollar character, it is expanded
+If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
before use. The following scanner types are supported in this release:
.vlist
number, and a port, separated by space, as in the second of these examples:
.code
av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
-av_scanner = clamd:192.168.2.100 1234
-.endd
+av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
+av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
+.endd
+If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the local
+keyword, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
+to be scanned, which will should normally result in less I/O happening and be
+more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
+Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
+There is an option WITH_OLD_CLAMAV_STREAM in &_src/EDITME_& available, should
+you be running a version of ClamAV prior to 0.95.
If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
contributing the code for this scanner.
.code
Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
.endd
-.new
For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
even if there is a problem with the virus scanner. Otherwise, such a problem
causes the ACL to defer.
-.cindex "&$malware_name$&"
+.vindex "&$malware_name$&"
When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
&$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
&%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
use the &%demime%& condition (see section &<<SECTdemimecond>>&) before the
&%malware%& condition.
+Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
+imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
+
Here is a very simple scanning example:
.code
deny message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
.section "Scanning with SpamAssassin" "SECTscanspamass"
.cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
.cindex "spam scanning"
-.cindex "SpamAssassin" "scanning with"
+.cindex "SpamAssassin"
The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
score and a report for the message. You can get SpamAssassin at
&url(http://www.spamassassin.org), or, if you have a working Perl
documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
nicely, however.
-.cindex "&%spamd_address%&"
+.oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
After having installed and configured SpamAssassin, start the &%spamd%& daemon.
By default, it listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783. If you use another host or
port for &%spamd%&, you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global
&*Warning*&: It is not possible to use the UNIX socket connection method with
multiple &%spamd%& servers.
+The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
+a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
+used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
+expansion.
-.section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL"
+.section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
.code
deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
spam = joe
.endd
-.new
The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
&"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
-.wen
Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
-large ones may cause significant performance degredation. As most spam messages
+large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
example:
.code
.cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
-variables. With the exception of &$spam_score_int$&, these are usable only
-within ACLs; their values are not retained with the message and so cannot be
-used at delivery time.
+variables. These variables are saved with the received message, thus they are
+available for use at delivery time.
.vlist
.vitem &$spam_score$&
.vitem &$spam_score_int$&
The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
-example &"34"& or &"305"&. This is useful for numeric comparisons in
-conditions. This variable is special; its value is saved with the message, and
-written to Exim's spool file. This means that it can be used during the whole
-life of the message on your Exim system, in particular, in routers or
-transports during the later delivery phase.
+example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
+because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
+The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
+
.vitem &$spam_bar$&
A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
.endlist
-The &%spam%& condition caches its results. If you call it again with the same
-user name, it does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as
-before.
+The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
+spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
+does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
-The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running the
-message through SpamAssassin. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to
-the next ACL statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of
-the spam condition, like this:
+The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
+the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
+failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
+statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
+spam condition, like this:
.code
deny message = This message was classified as SPAM
spam = joe/defer_ok
.section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
.cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
.cindex "MIME content scanning"
-.cindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
-.cindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
+.oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
+.oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
cases.
-These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the
-&%acl_smtp_data%& ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the
-&%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL
-is called only if the message contains a &'MIME-Version:'& header line. When a
-call to a MIME ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the
-appropriate result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message,
-the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
+These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
+ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
+the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
+message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
+ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
+result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
+&%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
-part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& modifier. The general syntax
-is:
+part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
+syntax is:
.display
&`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
.endd
If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
filename, and the default path is then used.
.endlist
-
-You can easily decode a file with its original, proposed filename using
+The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
+errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages. You can easily decode
+a file with its original, proposed filename using
.code
decode = $mime_filename
.endd
.vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
-attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unneccessarily encoded
+attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
errors in MIME containers and can match file extensions found in the message
against a list. Using this facility produces files containing the unpacked MIME
parts of the message in the temporary scan directory. If you do antivirus
-scanning, it is recommened that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
+scanning, it is recommended that you use the &%demime%& condition before the
antivirus (&%malware%&) condition.
On the right-hand side of the &%demime%& condition you can pass a
.vlist
.vitem &$demime_errorlevel$&
-.cindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
+.vindex "&$demime_errorlevel$&"
When an error is detected in a MIME container, this variable contains the
severity of the error, as an integer number. The higher the value, the more
severe the error (the current maximum value is 3). If this variable is unset or
zero, no error occurred.
.vitem &$demime_reason$&
-.cindex "&$demime_reason$&"
+.vindex "&$demime_reason$&"
When &$demime_errorlevel$& is greater than zero, this variable contains a
human-readable text string describing the MIME error that occurred.
.endlist
.vlist
.vitem &$found_extension$&
-.cindex "&$found_extension$&"
+.vindex "&$found_extension$&"
When the &%demime%& condition is true, this variable contains the file
extension it found.
.endlist
-.section "Building Exim to use a local scan function"
+.section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
function is before building Exim, by setting LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
.vlist
.vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
-.cindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
+.vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
printed with the suffix K or M.
.vitem &*opt_octint*&
-This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpeted as an
+This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
always output in octal.
-.section "Available Exim variables"
+.section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
-Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim variable by calling
-&'expand_string()'&. The exported variables are as follows:
+Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
+including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
+C variables are as follows:
.vlist
+.vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
+This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
+
+.vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
+This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
+
.vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
is NULL for locally submitted messages.
.vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
-.new
The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
-.wen
.vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
&%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
-below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and adusting
-the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
+below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
+adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
&%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
.endlist
-.section "Structure of header lines"
+.section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
(see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
-.section "Structure of recipient items"
+.section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
.vlist
-.section "Available Exim functions"
+.section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
.cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
.code
lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
.endd
-.cindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
+.vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
prevent it happening on retries.
-.cindex "&$domain$&"
-.cindex "&$local_part$&"
+.vindex "&$domain$&"
+.vindex "&$local_part$&"
&*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
&$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
-.section "Specifying a system filter"
+.section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
.cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
.cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
by the &%reply%& command.
-.section "Testing a system filter"
+.section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
-.section "Contents of a system filter"
+.section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
-.section "Additional variable for system filters"
-.cindex "&$recipients$&"
+.section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
+.vindex "&$recipients$&"
The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
-.section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters"
+.section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
.cindex "freezing messages"
.cindex "message" "freezing"
.cindex "message" "forced failure"
-.section "Setting an errors address in a system filter"
+.section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
.cindex "envelope sender"
In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
.code
.section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
-.cindex "&$domain$&"
-.cindex "&$local_part$&"
+.vindex "&$domain$&"
+.vindex "&$local_part$&"
In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
&%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
-state. Submisssion mode is set by the modifier
+state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
.code
control = submission
.endd
warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
control = submission
.endd
-.cindex "&%sender_retain%&"
+.cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
is used to separate options. For example:
.code
-.section "Unqualified addresses"
+.section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
.cindex "unqualified addresses"
.cindex "address" "qualification"
By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
-sender or receipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
+sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
&%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
-.cindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
-.cindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
+.oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
+.oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
-.section "The UUCP From line"
+.section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
.cindex "&""From""& line"
.cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
.cindex "sender" "address"
-.cindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
-.cindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
+.oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
+.oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
.cindex "envelope sender"
.cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
-.section "Resent- header lines"
+.section "Resent- header lines" "SECID220"
.cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines"
RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
&`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
-.section "The Auto-Submitted: header line"
+.section "The Auto-Submitted: header line" "SECID221"
Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
includes the header line:
.code
Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
.endd
-.section "The Bcc: header line"
+.section "The Bcc: header line" "SECID222"
.cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
-.section "The Date: header line"
+.section "The Date: header line" "SECID223"
.cindex "&'Date:'& header line"
If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
&%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
-.section "The Delivery-date: header line"
+.section "The Delivery-date: header line" "SECID224"
.cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
-.cindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
+.oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
&'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
messages.
-.section "The Envelope-to: header line"
+.section "The Envelope-to: header line" "SECID225"
.cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
-.cindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
+.oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
&'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
.next
-.cindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
+.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
.olist
-.cindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
+.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
.next
name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
-.section "The Message-ID: header line"
+.section "The Message-ID: header line" "SECID226"
.cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
.cindex "message" "submission"
-.cindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
+.oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
&'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
&%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
&%message_id_header_domain%& options.
-.section "The Received: header line"
+.section "The Received: header line" "SECID227"
.cindex "&'Received:'& header line"
A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
-H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
-.section "The References: header line"
+.section "The References: header line" "SECID228"
.cindex "&'References:'& header line"
Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
-.section "The Return-path: header line"
+.section "The Return-path: header line" "SECID229"
.cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line"
-.cindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
+.oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
&'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
-.cindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
+.vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
created as follows:
.ilist
-.cindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
+.vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
&$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
.next
an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
-.cindex "&%unseen%& option"
+.oindex "&%unseen%&"
However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
&"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
-.section "Case of local parts"
+.section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
.cindex "case of local parts"
.cindex "local part" "case of"
RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
-.section "Dots in local parts"
+.section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
.cindex "dot" "in local part"
.cindex "local part" "dots in"
RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
-.section "Rewriting addresses"
+.section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
.cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
-of the &%max_rcpts%& option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
-they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpts%& addresses
+of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
+they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
-.section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP"
+.section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
.cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
.cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
.cindex "inetd"
-.section "Unrecognized SMTP commands"
+.section "Unrecognized SMTP commands" "SECID234"
.cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
-.section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands"
+.section "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" "SECID235"
.cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
.cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
-.section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands"
+.section "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" "SECID236"
.cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
-but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurence of HELO
+but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
counted.
-.section "The VRFY and EXPN commands"
+.section "The VRFY and EXPN commands" "SECID237"
When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
-.cindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
+.oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
whatever the form of its argument. For
smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
$sender_host_address
.endd
-.cindex "&$domain$&"
+.vindex "&$domain$&"
The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
-.section "Incoming local SMTP"
+.section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
.cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
-.cindex "&$host$&"
+.vindex "&$host$&"
When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
to all warning and bounce messages,
-.section "Customizing bounce messages"
+.section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
.cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
.cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
item.
-.cindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
-.cindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
+.vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
+.vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
the message will be returned to you.
.endd
-.cindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
-.cindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
+.vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
+.vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
&$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
-.section "Sending mail to a smart host"
+.section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
.cindex "smart host" "example router"
If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
expanded into a file name or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
a mailing list.
-.cindex "&%errors_to%&"
+.oindex "&%errors_to%&"
The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
-.section "Syntax errors in mailing lists"
+.section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
.cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
-.section "Re-expansion of mailing lists"
+.section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
.cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
-.section "Closed mailing lists"
+.section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
.cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
.code
somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
.endd
-.cindex "&$local_part$&"
+.vindex "&$local_part$&"
For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
local_part_suffix_optional
allow_filter
.endd
-.cindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
+.vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
&'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
-.section "Simplified vacation processing"
+.section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
.cindex "vacation processing"
The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
-.section "Taking copies of mail"
+.section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
.cindex "message" "copying every"
Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
-.section "Intermittently connected hosts"
+.section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
.cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
-.section "Exim on the upstream server host"
+.section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
host to remain on Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
-.section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host"
+.section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
.chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
"Exim as a non-queueing client"
-.cindex "client" "non-queueing"
-.cindex "smart host" "queueing; suppressing"
+.cindex "client, non-queueing"
+.cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
-.cindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
+.oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
.next
-Each message is synchonously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
+Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
&%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
.next
A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
-true, &%max_rcpt%& in the smtp transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
+true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
&%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
.endlist
.endd
.endlist
+.cindex "log" "process ids in"
+.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
+Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
+request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
+&<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
+brackets, immediately after the time and date.
+
-.section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&"
+.section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
.cindex "log" "cycling local files"
.cindex "cycling logs"
.cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
.cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
-Some operating systems provide centralized and standardised methods for cycling
+Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
.endd
-.section "Logging to syslog"
+.section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
.cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
-.section "Log line flags"
+.section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
.endd
-.section "Logging message reception"
+.section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
.cindex "log" "reception line"
The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
-.section "Logging deliveries"
+.section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
.cindex "log" "delivery line"
The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
-.section "Discarded deliveries"
+.section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
.cindex "discarded messages"
.cindex "message" "discarded"
.cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
.endd
-.section "Deferred deliveries"
+.section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
.code
2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
-.section "Delivery failures"
+.section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
.cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
following form is logged:
-.section "Fake deliveries"
+.section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
.cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
-.section "Completion"
+.section "Completion" "SECID257"
A line of the form
.code
2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
-.section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines"
+.section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
.cindex "log" "summary of fields"
A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
the following table:
.display
&`A `& authenticator name (and optional id)
&`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
+&` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
&`CV `& certificate verification status
+&`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
&`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
&`DT `& on &`=>`& lines: time taken for a delivery
&`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
.endd
-.section "Other log entries"
+.section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
&`*queue_run `& start and end queue runs
&` queue_time `& time on queue for one recipient
&` queue_time_overall `& time on queue for whole message
+&` pid `& Exim process id
&` received_recipients `& recipients on <= lines
&` received_sender `& sender on <= lines
&`*rejected_header `& header contents on reject log
&` smtp_confirmation `& SMTP confirmation on => lines
&` smtp_connection `& SMTP connections
&` smtp_incomplete_transaction`& incomplete SMTP transactions
+&` smtp_no_mail `& session with no MAIL commands
&` smtp_protocol_error `& SMTP protocol errors
&` smtp_syntax_error `& SMTP syntax errors
&` subject `& contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines
More details on each of these items follows:
.ilist
-.cindex "&%warn%& statement" "log when skipping"
+.cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
&%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
this log selector is set.
parentheses between them.
.next
.cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
-.cindex "Exim arguments" "logging"
+.cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
&%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
.next
.cindex "log" "delayed delivery"
-.cindex "delayed delivery" "logging"
+.cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
&%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
.cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
.cindex "port" "logging remote"
.cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
-.cindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
-.cindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
+.vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
+.vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
&%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
the default setting, because for most ordinary configurations, the remote port
number is always 25 (the SMTP port).
.next
+.cindex "log" "process ids in"
+.cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
+&%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
+immediately after the time and date.
+.next
.cindex "log" "queue run"
.cindex "queue runner" "logging"
&%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
.next
+.cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
+.cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
+&%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
+connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
+the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
+does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
+an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
+already have their own log lines.
+
+The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
+way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
+If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
+an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
+DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
+the same logging options.
+
+Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
+is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
+.code
+C=EHLO,QUIT
+.endd
+shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
+than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
+the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
+setting of 10 for &%smtp_accep_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
+have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
+.next
.cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
.cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
&%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
.next
.cindex "log" "subject"
-.cindex "subject" "logging"
+.cindex "subject, logging"
&%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
.endlist
-.section "Message log"
+.section "Message log" "SECID260"
.cindex "message" "log file for"
.cindex "log" "message log; description of"
.cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
-.cindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
+.oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
.ecindex IIDloggen
+
+
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
-.itable none 0 0 4 2* left 8* left 30* left 40* left
-.row "" &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
+.itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
+.irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
"list what Exim processes are doing"
-.row "" &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
-.row "" &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
-.row "" &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
-.row "" &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
- various criteria"
-.row "" &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
-.row "" &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
+.irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
+.irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
+.irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
+.irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
+ various criteria"
+.irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
+.irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
"extract statistics from the log"
-.row "" &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
+.irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
"check address acceptance from given IP"
-.row "" &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
-.row "" &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
-.row "" &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
-.row "" &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
-.row "" &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
-.row "" &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
+.irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
+.irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
+.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
+.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
+.irow &<<SECThindatmai>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
+.irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
.endtable
Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
.section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
.cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
-.cindex "process" "querying"
+.cindex "process, querying"
.cindex "SIGUSR1"
On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
(most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
-.section "Summarising the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
+.section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
.cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
.cindex "queue" "summary"
The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
-.new
A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
sender.
-.wen
The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
-
-If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is always
-included in &'exigrep'&'s output. The usage is:
+If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
+included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
.display
-&`exigrep [-l] [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
+&`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
.endd
+If no log file names are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
+
The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds on the queue.
-The &%-l%& flag means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
+By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
+makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
+large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
+option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
+case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
+
+The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
-regular expression. The pattern match is case-insensitive. If no file names are
-given on the command line, the standard input is read.
+regular expression.
+
+The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
+if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
.section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
.cindex "&'exipick'&"
John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
-lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details,
-visit &url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run:
-.code
-exipick --help
-.endd
+lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
+of &'exipick'&'s facilities, visit the web page at
+&url(http://www.exim.org/eximwiki/ToolExipickManPage) or run &'exipick'& with
+the &%--help%& option.
.section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
.cindex "&'eximstats'&"
A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
-Exim log files are also suported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
+Exim log files are also supported by the &'Lire'& system produced by the
LogReport Foundation &url(http://www.logreport.org).
The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
-.section "exim_dumpdb"
+.section "exim_dumpdb" "SECID261"
.cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
&'exim_dumpdb'& program, which has no options or arguments other than the
of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
-address (unless &%no_retry_include_ip_address%& is set on the &(smtp)&
+address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
and a textual description of the error.
-.section "exim_tidydb"
+.section "exim_tidydb" "SECID262"
.cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
-.section "exim_fixdb"
+.section "exim_fixdb" "SECID263"
.cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
-.section "Running the monitor"
+.section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
-.section "The stripcharts"
+.section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
.cindex "stripchart"
The first stripchart is always a count of messages on the queue. Its name can
be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
-.section "Main action buttons"
+.section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
.cindex "size" "of monitor window"
.cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
.cindex "window size"
-.section "The log display"
+.section "The log display" "SECID267"
.cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
the main log is maintained.
-.section "The queue display"
+.section "The queue display" "SECID268"
.cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
are on the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
-.section "The queue menu"
+.section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
.cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
as soon as possible.
-.section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim"
+.section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
.cindex "security" "build-time features"
There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
.next
-If ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is defined, root privilege is retained for &%-C%&
-and &%-D%& only if the caller of Exim is root. Without it, the Exim user may
-also use &%-C%& and &%-D%& and retain privilege. Setting this option locks out
-the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message
-reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by
-that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain
-privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost.
-However, root can test reception and delivery using two separate commands.
-ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is not set by default.
+If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
+or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
+file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
+the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
+root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
+right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
+reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
+it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
+privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
+separate commands.
+.next
+The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
+with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
+CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
+requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
+the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
+but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
+previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
.next
If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
is disabled.
-.section "Root privilege"
+.section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
.cindex "setuid"
.cindex "root privilege"
The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
uid and gid in the following cases:
.ilist
-.cindex "&%-C%& option"
-.cindex "&%-D%& option"
+.oindex "&%-C%&"
+.oindex "&%-D%&"
If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
-calling process is not running as root or the Exim user, the uid and gid are
-changed to those of the calling process.
-However, if ALT_CONFIG_ROOT_ONLY is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, only
-root callers may use &%-C%& and &%-D%& without losing privilege, and if
-DISABLE_D_OPTION is set, the &%-D%& option may not be used at all.
-.next
-.cindex "&%-be%& option"
-.cindex "&%-bf%& option"
-.cindex "&%-bF%& option"
+calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
+the calling process.
+However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
+option may not be used at all.
+If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
+can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
+user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
+.next
+.oindex "&%-be%&"
+.oindex "&%-bf%&"
+.oindex "&%-bF%&"
If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
(&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
calling process.
uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
testing address verification
-.cindex "&%-bv%& option"
-.cindex "&%-bh%& option"
+.oindex "&%-bv%&"
+.oindex "&%-bh%&"
(the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
option).
.next
.section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
-.cindex "privilege" "running without"
+.cindex "privilege, running without"
.cindex "unprivileged running"
.cindex "root privilege" "running without"
Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
.olist
-They must be owned by the Exim group and be writable by that group. This
+They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
mode of the mailbox files themselves.
.next
-.section "Delivering to local files"
+.section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
-.section "IPv4 source routing"
+.section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
.cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
.cindex "IP source routing"
Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
-.section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP"
+.section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
-.section "Privileged users"
-.cindex "trusted user"
+.section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
+.cindex "trusted users"
.cindex "admin user"
.cindex "privileged user"
.cindex "user" "trusted"
.cindex "user" "admin"
-Exim recognises two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
+Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
permit a remote host to be specified.
-.cindex "&%-f%& option"
+.oindex "&%-f%&"
However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
includes the contents of files on the spool.
-.cindex "&%-M%& option"
-.cindex "&%-q%& option"
+.oindex "&%-M%&"
+.oindex "&%-q%&"
By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
-Exim recognises an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
+Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
-.section "Spool files"
+.section "Spool files" "SECID275"
.cindex "spool directory" "files"
Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
-.section "Use of argv[0]"
+.section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
-.section "Use of %f formatting"
+.section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
-.section "Embedded Exim path"
+.section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
-.section "Use of sprintf()"
+.section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
.cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
&'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
-.section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()"
+.section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
-.section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()"
+.section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
enough to hold the result.
.ecindex IIDsecurcon
place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
.next
-.cindex "&$body_linecount$&"
+.vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
&$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect. At
present, this value is not used by Exim, but there is no guarantee that this
If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
signature.
.endlist
-
+All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
-the course of a delivery run. At the end of the run, the -H file is updated,
-and the -J file is deleted.
-
+the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
+the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
+is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
+file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
+-J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
+attempt.
-.section "Format of the -H file"
+.section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
.cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
.cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
-message. For a message received over TCP/IP, it is normally the Exim user.
+message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
+normally the Exim user.
The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
newlines.
-.new
.vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
character. It may contain internal newlines.
-.wen
.vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
.ecindex IIDforspo2
.ecindex IIDforspo3
+. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+
+.chapter "Support for DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail) - RFC4871" "CHID12" &&&
+ "DKIM Support"
+.cindex "DKIM"
+
+Since version 4.70, DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default. It can be
+disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in Local/Makefile.
+
+Exim's DKIM implementation allows to
+.olist
+Sign outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
+It can co-exist with all other Exim features, including transport filters.
+.next
+Verify signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
+ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
+different signature contexts.
+.endlist
+
+In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
+default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
+Exim's standard controls.
+
+Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
+on by default for logging purposes. For each signature in incoming email,
+exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
+signature status. Here is an example:
+.code
+2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM: d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
+.endd
+You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
+or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
+control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
+where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
+senders).
+
+
+.section "Signing outgoing messages" "SECID513"
+.cindex "DKIM" "signing"
+
+Signing is implemented by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
+These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
+
+.option dkim_domain smtp string&!! unset
+MANDATORY:
+The domain you want to sign with. The result of this expanded
+option is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable.
+
+.option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
+MANDATORY:
+This sets the key selector string. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion
+variable to look up a matching selector. The result is put in the expansion
+variable &%$dkim_selector%& which should be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
+option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
+
+.option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
+MANDATORY:
+This sets the private key to use. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
+&%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
+The result can either
+.ilist
+be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor, including line breaks.
+.next
+start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
+the private key.
+.next
+be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
+be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
+is set.
+.endlist
+
+.option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
+OPTIONAL:
+This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
+The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
+The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
+only supports using the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
+
+.option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
+OPTIONAL:
+This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
+should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
+either "1" or "true", Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
+unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
+variables here.
+
+.option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! unset
+OPTIONAL:
+When set, this option must expand to (or be specified as) a colon-separated
+list of header names. Headers with these names will be included in the message
+signature. When unspecified, the header names recommended in RFC4871 will be
+used.
+
+.section "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" "SECID514"
+.cindex "DKIM" "verification"
+Verification of DKIM signatures in incoming email is implemented via the
+&%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL. By default, this ACL is called once for each
+syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
+
+To evaluate the signature in the ACL a large number of expansion variables
+containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
+runtime of the ACL.
+
+Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
+more advanced policies. For that reason, the global option
+&%dkim_verify_signers%&, and a global expansion variable
+&%$dkim_signers%& exist.
+
+The global option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
+list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
+called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
+the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
+list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
+&%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
+it defaults as:
+.code
+dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
+.endd
+This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
+DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
+call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
+.code
+dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
+.endd
+This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
+and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
+You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
+.code
+dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
+.endd
+
+If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
+&%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
+
+
+Inside the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&, the following expansion variables are
+available (from most to least important):
+
+.vlist
+.vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
+The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
+an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
+&%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
+.vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
+A string describing the general status of the signature. One of
+.ilist
+&%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
+identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
+.next
+&%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
+More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
+.next
+&%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
+available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
+.next
+&%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
+.endlist
+.vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
+A string giving a litte bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
+"fail" or "invalid". One of
+.ilist
+&%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
+key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
+.next
+&%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
+record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
+.next
+&%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
+body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
+means that the message body was modified in transit.
+.next
+&%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
+could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
+re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
+DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
+.endlist
+.vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
+The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
+an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
+reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
+.vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
+The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
+if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
+identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
+.vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
+The key record selector string.
+.vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
+The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
+.vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
+The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
+.vitem &%dkim_canon_headers%&
+The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
+.vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
+A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
+(copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
+.vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
+The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
+limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
+that this variable always expands to an integer value.
+.vitem &%$dkim_created%&
+UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
+When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
+.vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
+UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
+signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
+signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
+integer size comparisons against this value.
+.vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
+A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
+.vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
+"1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
+.vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomaining%&
+"1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
+.vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
+Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
+in the key record.
+.vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
+Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
+in the key record.
+.vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
+Notes from the key record (tag n=).
+.endlist
+
+In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
+
+.vlist
+.vitem &%dkim_signers%&
+ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
+for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
+(reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&). This is typically used to restrict an ACL
+verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
+
+.code
+# Warn when message apparently from GMail has no signature at all
+warn log_message = GMail sender without DKIM signature
+ sender_domains = gmail.com
+ dkim_signers = gmail.com
+ dkim_status = none
+.endd
+
+.vitem &%dkim_status%&
+ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
+results agains the actual result of verification. This is typically used
+to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, like:
+
+.code
+deny message = Message from Paypal with invalid or missing signature
+ sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
+ dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
+ dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
+.endd
+
+The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
+see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
+for more information of what they mean.
+.endlist
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
-.chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "" &&&
+.chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
"Adding drivers or lookups"
.cindex "adding drivers"
-.cindex "new drivers" "adding"
+.cindex "new drivers, adding"
.cindex "drivers" "adding new"
The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
. ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
-.makeindex "Option index" "option"
+. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+. These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
+. Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
+. PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
+. processors.
+. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
+
+.literal xml
+<?sdop
+ format="newpage"
+ foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
+ foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
+?>
+.literal off
-.makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
+.makeindex "Options index" "option"
+.makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
+.makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
. /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////